Yamaha Stereo Receiver HTR 6090 User Manual

U
HTR-6090  
AV Receiver  
OWNER’S MANUAL  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
10 Ventilation – Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided  
for ventilation and to ensure reliable operation of the  
product and to protect it from overheating, and these  
openings must not be blocked or covered. The openings  
should never be blocked by placing the product on a bed,  
sofa, rug, or other similar surface. This product should not  
be placed in a built-in installation such as a bookcase or rack  
unless proper ventilation is provided or the manufacturer’s  
instructions have been adhered to.  
CAUTION  
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK  
DO NOT OPEN  
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF  
ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE  
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE  
PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO  
QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.  
11 Power Sources – This product should be operated only from  
the type of power source indicated on the marking label. If  
you are not sure of the type of power supply to your home,  
consult your product dealer or local power company. For  
products intended to operate from battery power, or other  
sources, refer to the operating instructions.  
12 Grounding or Polarization – This product may be equipped  
with a polarized alternating current line plug (a plug having  
one blade wider than the other). This plug will fit into the  
power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you  
are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, try  
reversing the plug. If the plug should still fail to fit, contact  
your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not  
defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug.  
13 Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords should be  
routed so that they are not likely to be walked on or pinched  
by items placed upon or against them, paying particular  
attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the  
point where they exit from the product.  
14 Lightning – For added protection for this product during a  
lightning storm, or when it is left unattended and unused for  
long periods of time, unplug it from the wall outlet and  
disconnect the antenna or cable system. This will prevent  
damage to the product due to lightning and power-line  
surges.  
15 Power Lines – An outside antenna system should not be  
located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other  
electric light or power circuits, or where it can fall into such  
power lines or circuits. When installing an outside antenna  
system, extreme care should be taken to keep from touching  
such power lines or circuits as contact with them might be  
fatal.  
16 Overloading – Do not overload wall outlets, extension  
cords, or integral convenience receptacles as this can result  
in a risk of fire or electric shock.  
17 Object and Liquid Entry – Never push objects of any kind  
into this product through openings as they may touch  
dangerous voltage points or short-out parts that could result  
in a fire or electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind on  
the product.  
18 Servicing – Do not attempt to service this product yourself  
as opening or removing covers may expose you to  
dangerous voltage or other hazards. Refer all servicing to  
qualified service personnel.  
Explanation of Graphical Symbols  
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an  
equilateral triangle, is intended to alert you to the  
presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within  
the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient  
magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to  
persons.  
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle  
is intended to alert you to the presence of important  
operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in  
the literature accompanying the appliance.  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Read Instructions – All the safety and operating instructions  
should be read before the product is operated.  
Retain Instructions – The safety and operating instructions  
should be retained for future reference.  
Heed Warnings – All warnings on the product and in the  
operating instructions should be adhered to.  
Follow Instructions – All operating and use instructions  
should be followed.  
Cleaning – Unplug this product from the wall outlet before  
cleaning. Do not use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners.  
Attachments – Do not use attachments not recommended by  
the product manufacturer as they may cause hazards.  
Water and Moisture – Do not use this product near water –  
for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink, or  
laundry tub; in a wet basement; or near a swimming pool;  
and the like.  
Accessories – Do not place this product on an unstable cart,  
stand, tripod, bracket, or table. The product may fall,  
causing serious injury to a child or adult, and serious  
damage to the product. Use only with a cart, stand, tripod,  
bracket, or table recommended by the manufacturer, or sold  
with the product. Any mounting of the product should  
follow the manufacturer’s instructions, and should use a  
mounting accessory recommended by the manufacturer.  
A product and cart combination should be moved with care.  
Quick stops, excessive force, and uneven surfaces may  
cause the product and cart combination to  
8
9
overturn.  
19 Damage Requiring Service – Unplug this product from the  
wall outlet and refer servicing to qualified service personnel  
under the following conditions:  
a) When the power-supply cord or plug is damaged,  
b) If liquid has been spilled, or objects have fallen into the  
product,  
c) If the product has been exposed to rain or water,  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS  
d) If the product does not operate normally by following  
the operating instructions. Adjust only those controls  
that are covered by the operating instructions as an  
improper adjustment of other controls may result in  
damage and will often require extensive work by a  
qualified technician to restore the product to its normal  
operation,  
24 Outdoor Antenna Grounding – If an outside antenna or  
cable system is connected to the product, be sure the antenna  
or cable system is grounded so as to provide some  
protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges.  
Article 810 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70,  
provides information with regard to proper grounding of the  
mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in wire  
to an antenna discharge unit, size of grounding conductors,  
location of antenna discharge unit, connection to grounding  
electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode.  
e) If the product has been dropped or damaged in any  
way, and  
f)  
When the product exhibits a distinct change in perfor-  
mance - this indicates a need for service.  
EXAMPLE OF ANTENNA GROUNDING  
20 Replacement Parts – When replacement parts are required,  
be sure the service technician has used replacement parts  
specified by the manufacturer or have the same  
characteristics as the original part. Unauthorized  
substitutions may result in fire, electric shock, or other  
hazards.  
ANTENNA  
LEAD IN  
WIRE  
MAST  
21 Safety Check – Upon completion of any service or repairs to  
this product, ask the service technician to perform safety  
checks to determine that the product is in proper operating  
condition.  
GROUND  
CLAMP  
ANTENNA  
DISCHARGE UNIT  
(NEC SECTION 810–20)  
22 Wall or Ceiling Mounting – The unit should be mounted  
to a wall or ceiling only as recommended by the  
manufacturer.  
23 Heat – The product should be situated away from heat  
sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other  
products (including amplifiers) that produce heat.  
ELECTRIC  
SERVICE  
EQUIPMENT  
GROUNDING CONDUCTORS  
(NEC SECTION 810–21)  
GROUND CLAMPS  
POWER SERVICE GROUNDING  
ELECTRODE SYSTEM  
(NEC ART 250. PART H)  
Note to CATV system installer:  
This reminder is provided to call the CATV system  
installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the NEC that  
provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in  
particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be  
connected to the grounding system of the building, as  
close to the point of cable entry as practical.  
NEC – NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE  
FCC INFORMATION (for US customers)  
1
IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS  
UNIT!  
Compliance with FCC regulations does not guarantee that  
interference will not occur in all installations. If this  
product is found to be the source of interference, which  
can be determined by turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”,  
please try to eliminate the problem by using one of the  
following measures:  
This product, when installed as indicated in the  
instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC  
requirements. Modifications not expressly approved by  
Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to  
use the product.  
IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to  
accessories and/or another product use only high quality  
shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product MUST  
be used. Follow all installation instructions. Failure to  
follow instructions could void your FCC authorization to  
use this product in the USA.  
NOTE: This product has been tested and found to comply  
with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, Part 15  
for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with these  
requirements provides a reasonable level of assurance that  
your use of this product in a residential environment will  
not result in harmful interference with other electronic  
devices.  
Relocate either this product or the device that is being  
affected by the interference.  
2
3
Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit  
breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.  
In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient  
the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon lead,  
change the lead-in to coaxial type cable.  
If these corrective measures do not produce satisfactory  
results, please contact the local retailer authorized to  
distribute this type of product. If you can not locate the  
appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Electronics  
Corp., U.S.A. 6660 Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA  
90620.  
The above statements apply ONLY to those products  
distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its  
subsidiaries.  
This equipment generates/uses radio frequencies and, if  
not installed and used according to the instructions found  
in the users manual, may cause interference harmful to the  
operation of other electronic devices.  
ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.  
CAUTION: READ THIS BEFORE OPERATING YOUR UNIT.  
1
2
To assure the finest performance, please read this manual  
carefully. Keep it in a safe place for future reference.  
Install this sound system in a well ventilated, cool, dry, clean  
place – away from direct sunlight, heat sources, vibration,  
dust, moisture, and/or cold. Allow ventilation space of at least  
30 cm on the top, 20 cm on the left and right, and 20 cm on  
the back of this unit.  
15 When not planning to use this unit for long periods of time  
(i.e. vacation), disconnect the AC power plug from the wall  
outlet.  
16 Install this unit near the AC outlet and where the AC power  
plug can be reached easily.  
17 Be sure to read the “TROUBLESHOOTING” section on  
common operating errors before concluding that this unit is  
faulty.  
3
4
Locate this unit away from other electrical appliances, motors,  
or transformers to avoid humming sounds.  
18 Before moving this unit, press MASTER ON/OFF to release it  
outward to the OFF position to turn off this unit, the main  
room and Zone 2 and then disconnect the AC power plug from  
the AC wall outlet.  
Do not expose this unit to sudden temperature changes from  
cold to hot, and do not locate this unit in an environment with  
high humidity (i.e. a room with a humidifier) to prevent  
condensation inside this unit, which may cause an electrical  
shock, fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.  
Avoid installing this unit where foreign objects may fall onto  
this unit and/or this unit may be exposed to liquid dripping or  
splashing. On the top of this unit, do not place:  
WARNING  
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC  
SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS UNIT TO RAIN  
OR MOISTURE.  
5
Other components, as they may cause damage and/or  
discoloration on the surface of this unit.  
As long as this unit is connected to the AC wall outlet,  
it is not disconnected from the AC power source even  
if you turn off this unit by MASTER ON/OFF. In this  
state, this unit is designed to consume a very small  
quantity of power.  
Burning objects (i.e. candles), as they may cause fire,  
damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.  
Containers with liquid in them, as they may fall and liquid  
may cause electrical shock to the user and/or damage to  
this unit.  
6
Do not cover this unit with a newspaper, tablecloth, curtain,  
etc. in order not to obstruct heat radiation. If the temperature  
inside this unit rises, it may cause fire, damage to this unit,  
and/or personal injury.  
FOR CANADIAN CUSTOMERS  
To prevent electric shock, match wide blade of plug to  
wide slot and fully insert.  
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian  
ICES-003.  
7
8
9
Do not plug in this unit to a wall outlet until all connections  
are complete.  
Do not operate this unit upside-down. It may overheat,  
possibly causing damage.  
POUR LES CONSOMMATEURS CANADIENS  
Pour éviter les chocs électriques, introduire la lame la  
plus large de la fiche dans la borne correspondante de  
la prise et pousser jusqu’au fond.  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à  
la norme NMB-003 du Canada.  
Do not use force on switches, knobs and/or cords.  
10 When disconnecting the power cable from the wall outlet,  
grasp the plug; do not pull the cable.  
11 Do not clean this unit with chemical solvents; this might  
damage the finish. Use a clean, dry cloth.  
12 Only voltage specified on this unit must be used. Using this  
unit with a higher voltage than specified is dangerous and may  
cause fire, damage to this unit, and/or personal injury.  
YAMAHA will not be held responsible for any damage  
resulting from use of this unit with a voltage other than  
specified.  
IMPORTANT  
Please record the serial number of this unit in the space  
below.  
MODEL:  
13 To prevent damage by lightning, keep the power cord and  
outdoor antennas disconnected from a wall outlet or the unit  
during a lightning storm.  
Serial No.:  
The serial number is located on the rear of the unit.  
Retain this Owner’s Manual in a safe place for future  
reference.  
14 Do not attempt to modify or fix this unit. Contact qualified  
YAMAHA service personnel when any service is needed. The  
cabinet should never be opened for any reasons.  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTENTS  
FM/AM TUNING..................................................53  
INTRODUCTION  
FM/AM controls and functions ............................... 53  
Automatic tuning ..................................................... 54  
Manual tuning.......................................................... 55  
Automatic preset tuning........................................... 56  
Manual preset tuning ............................................... 57  
Selecting preset stations........................................... 58  
Exchanging preset stations ...................................... 59  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING ...................60  
Connecting the XM Passport System ...................... 60  
XM Satellite Radio controls and functions.............. 61  
Activating XM Satellite Radio ................................ 62  
Basic XM Satellite Radio operations....................... 64  
Setting the XM Satellite Radio preset channels ...... 69  
Displaying the XM Satellite Radio information...... 70  
USING iPod ...........................................................72  
Controlling iPod ...................................................... 72  
RECORDING........................................................74  
FEATURES............................................................. 2  
GETTING STARTED............................................ 3  
Supplied accessories.................................................. 3  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS ......................... 4  
Front panel................................................................. 4  
Remote control........................................................... 6  
Preparing the remote control ..................................... 8  
Front panel display .................................................... 9  
Rear panel................................................................ 11  
PREPARATION  
CONNECTIONS .................................................. 12  
Placing speakers....................................................... 12  
Connecting speakers................................................ 13  
Using bi-amplification connections......................... 16  
Information on jacks and cable plugs...................... 17  
Information on HDMI.............................................. 18  
Audio and video signal flow.................................... 19  
Connecting a TV monitor or projector .................... 20  
Connecting other components ................................. 21  
Connecting a multi-format player  
ADVANCED OPERATION  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS.....75  
Changing sound field parameter settings................. 75  
Selecting decoders ................................................... 79  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT  
or an external decoder ......................................... 25  
Connecting a YAMAHA iPod universal dock ........ 26  
Using the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel .... 26  
Connecting the FM and AM antennas..................... 27  
Connecting the power cable..................................... 28  
Setting the speaker impedance................................. 29  
Turning on and off the power.................................. 30  
AUTO SETUP....................................................... 31  
Using AUTO SETUP .............................................. 31  
(MANUAL SETUP) ..........................................83  
Using SET MENU................................................... 85  
1 BASIC MENU...................................................... 86  
2 SOUND MENU.................................................... 90  
3 INPUT MENU...................................................... 93  
4 OPTION MENU................................................... 96  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES .................100  
Controlling this unit, a TV,  
or other components .......................................... 100  
Setting remote control codes ................................. 102  
Programming codes from other remote controls ... 104  
Changing source names in the display window..... 105  
Macro programming features ................................ 106  
Clearing configurations ......................................... 109  
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION...112  
Connecting the Zone 2 components ...................... 112  
Controlling Zone 2................................................. 113  
ADVANCED SETUP..........................................117  
Using ADVANCED SETUP................................. 117  
Setting remote control ID ...................................... 119  
BASIC OPERATION  
PLAYBACK.......................................................... 37  
Basic procedure ....................................................... 37  
Selecting audio input jacks (AUDIO SELECT)...... 39  
Selecting the MULTI CH INPUT component......... 40  
Using your headphones............................................ 40  
Muting the audio output........................................... 40  
Displaying the input source information ................. 41  
Playing video sources  
in the background of an audio source.................. 42  
Using the sleep timer ............................................... 42  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS............................. 43  
Selecting sound field programs ............................... 43  
Sound field program descriptions............................ 44  
Enjoying unprocessed input sources........................ 48  
USING AUDIO FEATURES............................... 49  
Enjoying pure hi-fi sound........................................ 49  
Adjusting the tonal quality....................................... 49  
Adjusting the speaker level...................................... 50  
Enjoying multi-channel sources  
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION  
TROUBLESHOOTING .....................................122  
RESETTING THE SYSTEM.............................130  
GLOSSARY.........................................................131  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM  
INFORMATION.............................................134  
PARAMETRIC EQUALIZER  
INFORMATION.............................................135  
SPECIFICATIONS.............................................136  
in 2-channel stereo............................................... 50  
Selecting the Compressed Music  
Enhancer mode.................................................... 51  
Selecting the night listening mode........................... 52  
APPENDIX (at the end of this manual)  
• SOUND OUTPUT IN EACH SOUND FIELD  
PROGRAM  
• LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL CODES  
1 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FEATURES  
FEATURES  
Built-in 7-channel power amplifier  
iPod controlling capability  
Minimum RMS output power  
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.04% THD, 8 )  
Front: 120 W + 120 W  
DOCK terminal to connect a YAMAHA iPod universal dock  
(such as the YDS-10, sold separately), which supports iPod  
(Click and Wheel), iPod nano, and iPod mini  
Center: 120 W  
Surround: 120 W + 120 W  
Surround back: 120 W + 120 W  
Other features  
YPAO (YAMAHA Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer) for  
automatic speaker setup  
Sound field programs  
192-kHz/24-bit D/A converter  
Proprietary YAMAHA technology for the creation of sound  
fields  
Dolby Digital/Dolby Digital EX decoder  
DTS/DTS-ES Matrix 6.1, Discrete 6.1, DTS Neo:6,  
DTS 96/24 decoder  
Dolby Pro Logic/Dolby Pro Logic II/Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
decoder  
Neural Surround decoder  
OSD (on-screen display) menus that allow you to optimize  
this unit to suit your individual audiovisual system  
6 or 8-channel additional input jacks for discrete multi-  
channel input  
Analog video interlace/progressive conversion from 480i  
(NTSC)/576i (PAL) to 480p/576p  
S-video signal input/output capability  
Component video input/output capability includes  
(3 COMPONENT VIDEO INs and 1 MONITOR OUT)  
Optical and coaxial digital audio signal jacks  
Pure Direct mode for pure hi-fi sound for all sources  
Cinema and music night listening modes  
Compressed Music Enhancer mode to improve the sound  
quality of compression artifacts (such as the MP3 format) to  
that of a high-quality stereo  
Virtual CINEMA DSP  
SILENT CINEMA  
Sophisticated AM/FM tuner  
40-station random and direct preset tuning  
Automatic preset tuning  
Preset station shifting capability (preset editing)  
Remote control with preset remote control codes, learning and  
macro capability  
Zone 2 custom installation facility  
Zone switching capability between the main zone and Zone 2  
using ZONE 2 CONTROLS  
Sleep timer  
XM Satellite Radio  
XM Satellite Radio tuning capability (using the “XM Passport  
System” sold separately)  
Neural Surround decoder to play back the surround sound  
content of XM Satellite Radio broadcasts in multi-channels,  
resulting in a full surround sound experience  
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface)  
HDMI interface for standard, enhanced or high-definition  
video (includes 1080p video signal transmission) as well as  
multi-channel digital audio based on HDMI version 1.2a  
Analog video to HDMI digital video up-conversion  
(composite video S-video component video HDMI  
digital video) capability for monitor out  
“HDMI”, the “HDMI” logo and “High-Definition Multimedia  
Interface” are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI  
Licensing LLC.  
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.  
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic”, and the double-D symbol are trademarks  
of Dolby Laboratories.  
“SILENT CINEMA” is a trademark of YAMAHA  
CORPORATION.  
Manufactured under license from Digital Theater Systems, Inc.  
“DTS”, “DTS-ES”, “NEO:6”, and “DTS 96/24” are trademarks  
of Digital Theater Systems, Inc. Copyright 1996, 2003 Digital  
Theater Systems, Inc. All right reserved.  
The XM name and related logos are registered trademarks of XM  
Satellite Radio Inc.  
®
iPod  
“iPod” is a trademark of Apple Computer, Inc., registered in the  
U.S. and other countries.  
Neural Surroundname and related logos are trademarks owned  
by Neural Audio Corporation.  
2 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GETTING STARTED  
GETTING STARTED  
Supplied accessories  
Check that you received all of the following parts.  
Remote control  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
PHONO  
TUNER  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
Batteries (4)  
(AAA, R03, UM-4)  
SELECT  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
5
6
7
8
NIGHT ENHANCER  
9
0
+
10  
ENT  
REC  
DISC SKIP  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
Speaker terminal wrench  
Power cable  
Optimizer microphone  
Indoor FM antenna  
AM loop antenna  
About this manual  
yindicates a tip for your operation.  
• Some operations can be performed by using either the buttons on the front panel or the ones on the remote control. In case the  
button names differ between the front panel and the remote control, the button name on the remote control is given in  
parentheses.  
• This manual is printed prior to production. Design and specifications are subject to change in part as a result of improvements,  
etc. In case of differences between the manual and product, the product has priority.  
3 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Front panel  
This section describes only the amplifier controls and functions of this unit. See the following pages for details about  
other control and functions.  
• AM/FM tuning ........................... see page 53  
• XM satellite radio tuning ........... see page 61  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
SEARCH MODE  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MASTER  
CATEGORY  
DISPLAY  
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE 2 VOLUME  
PHONES  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
VIDEO  
VIDEO  
L
AUDIO  
R
OPTICAL  
8
9
0
A
B
C
D
E
F
G H I J  
1 MASTER ON/OFF  
4 ZONE 2 CONTROLS  
Turns this unit on or off (see page 30).  
Activates the Zone 2 control mode while Zone 2 is turned  
on (see page 113).  
2 MAIN ZONE ON/OFF  
Turns on the main zone or sets it to the standby mode (see  
page 30).  
y
After you press ZONE 2 CONTROLS, the ZONE2 indicator  
flashes in the front panel display for approximately 5 seconds.  
While the indicator is flashing, perform the desired operation.  
Notes  
5 Remote control sensor  
Receives signals from the remote control (see page 8).  
• In the standby mode, this unit consumes a small amount of  
power in order to receive infrared signals from the remote  
control.  
• When you turn on this unit, there will be a 4 to 5-second delay  
before this unit can reproduce sound.  
6 Front panel display  
Shows information about the operational status of this unit  
(see page 9).  
• This button is operational only when MASTER ON/OFF is  
pressed inward to the ON position.  
7 VOLUME  
3 ZONE 2 ON/OFF  
Controls the output level of all audio channels.  
Turns on Zone 2 only or sets it to the standby mode. See  
page 113 for details.  
y
This does not affect the AUDIO OUT (REC) level.  
8 OPTIMIZER MIC jack  
Note  
Use to connect and input audio signals from the supplied  
optimizer microphone in the “AUTO SETUP” procedure  
(see page 31).  
These buttons are operational only when MASTER ON/OFF is  
pressed inward to the ON position.  
4 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
G INPUT selector  
9
PHONES jack  
Selects the desired input source (see page 37).  
Outputs audio signals for private listening with  
headphones (see page 40).  
H ZONE 2 INPUT  
Activates the Zone 2 input select mode (see page 115).  
0 ENHANCER  
Turns on or off the Compressed Music Enhancer mode  
(see page 51).  
I ZONE 2 VOLUME  
Activates the Zone 2 volume control mode (see page 115).  
A NIGHT  
J VIDEO AUX jacks  
Turns on or off the night listening modes (see page 52).  
Input audio and video signals from a portable external  
source such as a game console or a video camera (see  
page 26).  
B PURE DIRECT  
Turns on or off the Pure Direct mode (see page 49).  
y
C STRAIGHT  
To reproduce the source signals input at these jacks, select “V-  
AUX” as the input source.  
Turns the sound field programs off or on. When the  
“STRAIGHT” mode is selected, 2-channel or multi-  
channel input signals are output directly from their  
respective speakers without effect processing (see  
page 48).  
Note  
The audio signals input at the DOCK terminal on the rear panel  
take priority over the ones input at the VIDEO AUX jacks.  
D PROGRAM selector  
• Selects sound field programs (see page 43).  
• Adjusts the bass/treble balance in conjunction with  
TONE CONTROL (see page 49).  
E TONE CONTROL  
Adjusts the bass/treble balance of the front left, front right  
and center channels in conjunction with the PROGRAM  
selector (see page 49).  
F AUDIO SELECT  
Toggles the priority for the type of audio input jack  
between “AUTO”, “HDMI”, “COAX/OPT” and  
“ANALOG” when one component is connected to two or  
more input jacks (see page 39).  
5 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Remote control  
Remote control controls and functions  
This section describes only the amplifier controls and functions of this unit. See the following pages for details about  
other control and functions.  
• AM/FM tuning ........................................ see page 53  
• XM satellite radio tuning ........................ see page 61  
• Controlling a TV ................................... see page 100  
• Controlling other components ............... see page 101  
• Controlling option components ............. see page 102  
1
Note  
B
2
The operation mode of the remote control buttons in the shaded  
area below depends on the operation mode selector position. Set  
the operation mode selector to AMP to control this unit.  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
POWER  
STANDBY  
C
D
E
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
1 Infrared window  
Outputs infrared control signals. Aim this window at the  
component you want to operate (see page 8).  
PHONO  
TUNER  
F
3
4
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
2 TRANSMIT indicator  
Flashes while the remote control is sending infrared  
signals.  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
3 Input selector buttons  
Select the input source you want to control.  
SELECT  
G
H
y
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
VOLUME  
The selected input source name appears in the display window on  
the remote control showing which source is currently operational.  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
4 Display window  
Shows the name of the selected input source that you can  
control.  
I
J
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
MENU  
5
6
7
8
K
L
5 LEVEL  
SRCH MODE  
Selects the speaker channel to be adjusted and sets the  
output level (see page 50).  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
M
N
PARAMETER  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
6 Cursor buttons k/ n/ l/ h, ENTER  
Select and adjust the sound field program parameters or  
the “SET MENU” parameters.  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
XM MEMORY  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
7 RETURN  
Returns to the previous menu level when adjusting the  
“SET MENU” parameters.  
O
P
Q
8
5
6
7
NIGHT ENHANCER  
9
9
0
+
10  
ENT  
R
8 Sound field program selector buttons  
Select sound field programs (see page 43).  
REC  
9 SUR. DECODE  
Activates decoders to play back 2-channel sources in  
surround (see page 79).  
DISC SKIP  
S
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
0
A
t
U
6 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
0 MACRO ON/OFF  
I VOLUME +/–  
Turns on or off the macro function (see page 106).  
Increases or decreases the volume level.  
A MACRO  
J MUTE  
Programs a series of operations to be controlled with a  
single button (see page 106).  
Mutes the audio output. Press again to restore the audio  
output to the previous volume level (see page 40).  
B STANDBY  
K PURE DIRECT  
Sets the main zone to the standby mode (see page 30).  
Turns on or off the pure direct mode (see page 49).  
L SET MENU  
Enters “SET MENU” (see page 85).  
Note  
This button is operational only when MASTER ON/OFF on the  
front panel is pressed inward to the ON position.  
M PARAMETER  
Displays sound field parameter settings in the on-screen  
display (OSD) (see page 75).  
C POWER  
Turns on the main zone (see page 30).  
N STRAIGHT  
Note  
Turns the sound field programs off or on. When the  
“STRAIGHT” mode is selected, 2-channel or multi-  
channel input signals are output directly from their  
respective speakers without effect processing (see  
page 48).  
This button is operational only when MASTER ON/OFF on the  
front panel is pressed inward to the ON position.  
D AUDIO SEL  
Toggles the priority for the type of audio input jack  
between “AUTO”, “HDMI”, “COAX/OPT” and  
“ANALOG” when one component is connected to two or  
more input jacks (see page 39).  
O EXTD SUR.  
Switches between 5.1 and 6.1/7.1-channel playback of  
multi-channel sources (see page 79).  
P SELECT  
E SLEEP  
Selects decoders for 2-channel sources (see pages 79 and  
81).  
Sets the sleep timer (see page 42).  
F MULTI CH IN  
Q ENHANCER  
Turns on or off the Compressed Music Enhancer mode  
(see page 51).  
Selects the component connected to the MULTI CH  
INPUT jacks as the input source when using an external  
decoder, etc. (see page 40).  
R NIGHT  
G SELECT k/ n  
Turns on or off the night listening modes (see page 52).  
Selects another input source that you can control  
independently of the input source selected with the input  
selector buttons.  
S RENAME  
Changes the name of the input source in the display  
window (see page 105).  
H Operation mode selector  
Selects the operation mode of the remote control buttons  
in the shaded area.  
T CLEAR  
Clears remote control functions acquired from the learn,  
macro and/or rename features (see page 109).  
AMP  
Operates the amplifier function of this unit.  
U LEARN  
SOURCE  
Programs remote control codes of functions from other  
remote controls (see page 104).  
Operates the component selected with an input  
selector button (see page 101).  
TV  
Operates the TV assigned to either DTV or PHONO  
(see page 100).  
Notes  
• To set the remote control codes for other components, see  
page 102.  
• When you set the remote control codes for both DTV and  
PHONO (see page 102), priority is given to the one set for  
DTV.  
7 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Preparing the remote control  
Installing batteries in the remote control  
Using the remote control  
The remote control transmits a directional infrared ray.  
Be sure to aim the remote control directly at the remote  
control sensor on this unit during operation.  
Remote control sensor  
2
1
3
Approximately 6 m (20 ft)  
30  
30  
1
2
Press the  
compartment cover off.  
part and slide the battery  
Insert the four supplied batteries (AAA, R03,  
UM-4) according to the polarity markings on  
the inside of the battery compartment.  
Notes  
• Do not spill water or other liquids on the remote control.  
• Do not drop the remote control.  
• Do not leave or store the remote control in the following types  
of conditions:  
3
Slide the cover back until it snaps into place.  
Notes  
– places of high humidity, such as near a bath  
– places of high temperatures, such as near a heater or stove  
– places of extremely low temperatures  
– dusty places  
• Change all of the batteries if you notice the following  
conditions:  
– the operation range of the remote control decreases.  
– the TRANSMIT indicator does not flash or its light becomes  
dim.  
• Do not use old batteries together with new ones.  
• Do not use different types of batteries (such as alkaline and  
manganese batteries) together. Read the packaging carefully as  
these different types of batteries may have the same shape and  
color.  
• If the batteries have leaked, dispose of them immediately. Avoid  
touching the leaked material or letting it come into contact with  
clothing, etc. Clean the battery compartment thoroughly before  
installing new batteries.  
• Do not throw away batteries with general house waste; dispose  
of them correctly in accordance with your local regulations.  
• If the remote control is without batteries for more than 2  
minutes, or if exhausted batteries remain in the remote control,  
the contents of the memory may be cleared. When the memory  
is cleared, insert new batteries, set up the remote control code  
and program any acquired functions that may have been  
cleared.  
8 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Front panel display  
1
2
3
4
5
6
V-AUX DVR/VCR 2 VCR 1 CBL/SAT DTV DVD  
MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER  
XM  
DOCK  
neural  
TUNED STEREO  
AUTO MEMORY  
VIRTUAL  
YPAO HiFi DSP SILENT  
ENHANCER CINEMA  
DIGITAL  
dB  
ZONE2  
VOLUME MUTE  
DSD  
PCM  
96/24  
PL  
x
EX  
DISCRETE  
LL C R  
LFE SL SB SR  
NIGHT  
SLEEP  
MATRIX  
96  
24  
0
7
8
9
L
TUNED STEREO  
AUTO MEMORY  
neural  
A
B
C
D
E
H
VIRTUAL  
YPAO ENHANCER  
HiFi DSP  
ZONE2  
M
I
SILENT  
CINEMA  
DIGITAL  
PL  
N
O
NIGHT  
SLEEP  
DSD  
J
x
EX  
DISCRETE  
MATRIX  
PCM  
96  
24  
F
G
K
1 HDMI indicator  
8 96/24 indicator  
Lights up when the signal of the selected input source is  
input at HDMI IN 1 or HDMI IN 2 jacks (see page 18).  
Lights up when a DTS 96/24 signal is input to this unit.  
9 Input channel and speaker indicators  
Presence speaker indicators  
2 DOCK indicator  
Lights up when you station your iPod in a YAMAHA iPod  
universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold separately)  
connected to the DOCK terminal of this unit (see  
page 26).  
L C R  
LFE SL SB SR  
Input channel indicators  
Surround back speaker indicators  
Input channel indicators  
Indicate the channel components of the current digital  
input signal.  
3 Battery charge indicator  
Lights up when this unit charges the battery of the  
stationed iPod in the standby mode of this unit (see  
page 72).  
Presence and surround back speaker  
indicators  
4 Input source indicators  
Light up according to the number of presence and  
surround back speakers set for “PRESENCE SP” (see  
page 88) and “SB L/R SP” (see page 88) in “SOUND  
MENU” when “TEST” in “SOUND MENU” is set to  
“ON” (see page 91).  
The corresponding cursor lights up to show the currently  
selected input source.  
5 VOLUME level indicator  
Indicates the current volume level.  
6 MUTE indicator  
y
Flashes while the MUTE function is on (see page 40).  
You can make settings for the presence and surround back  
speakers automatically by running “AUTO SETUP” (see  
page 31) or manually by adjusting settings for “PRESENCE SP”  
(see page 88) and “SB L/R SP” (see page 88) in “SOUND  
MENU”.  
7 Multi-information display  
Shows the name of the current sound field program and  
other information when adjusting or changing settings.  
9 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
0 neural indicator  
I Headphones indicator  
Lights up when the Neural Surround decoder is activated  
(see page 80).  
Lights up when headphones are connected (see page 40).  
J SILENT CINEMA indicator  
A DSP indicators  
The respective indicator lights up when any of the DSP  
sound field programs are selected.  
Lights up when headphones are connected and a sound  
field program is selected (see page 48).  
K DTS decoder indicators  
CINEMA DSP indicator  
Lights up when you select a CINEMA DSP sound  
field program (see page 44).  
The respective indicator lights up when any of the DTS  
decoders of this unit function.  
L Tuner indicators  
HiFi DSP indicator  
Lights up when you select a HiFi DSP sound field  
program (see page 44).  
Lights up when this unit is in the FM, AM or XM Satellite  
Radio tuning mode.  
TUNED indicator  
B VIRTUAL indicator  
Lights up when Virtual CINEMA DSP is active (see  
page 48).  
Lights up when this unit is tuned into a station (see  
page 53).  
STEREO indicator  
C YPAO indicator  
Lights up when this unit is receiving a strong signal  
for an FM stereo broadcast while the AUTO indicator  
is lit (see page 53).  
Lights up when you run “AUTO SETUP” and when the  
speaker settings set in “AUTO SETUP” are used without  
any modifications (see page 31).  
AUTO indicator  
D DSD indicator  
Lights up when this unit is producing DSD (Direct Stream  
Digital) digital audio signals.  
Lights up when this unit is in the automatic tuning  
mode (see page 53).  
MEMORY indicator  
E ENHANCER indicator  
Lights up when the Compressed Music Enhancer mode is  
turned on (see page 51).  
Flashes to show that a station can be stored (see  
page 56).  
M ZONE2 indicator  
F PCM indicator  
Lights up when Zone 2 is turned on (see page 113).  
Lights up when this unit is reproducing PCM (Pulse Code  
Modulation) digital audio signals.  
N NIGHT indicator  
Lights up when you select a night listening mode (see  
page 52).  
G Dolby decoder indicators  
The respective indicator lights up when any of the Dolby  
decoders of this unit function.  
O SLEEP indicator  
Lights up while the sleep timer is on (see page 42).  
H Sound field indicators  
Light up to indicate the active DSP sound fields.  
Presence DSP sound field  
Listening position  
Surround left  
DSP sound field  
Surround right  
DSP sound field  
Surround back DSP sound field  
10 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTROLS AND FUNCTIONS  
Rear panel  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
COMPONENTVIDEO  
VIDEO  
ANTENNA  
DVD  
CBL/SAT IN  
VCR 1 OUT IN DVR/VCR 2 OUT  
MONITOR OUT  
SVIDEO  
MONITOR OUT  
Y
DTV  
DVD  
DTV  
CBL/SAT  
A
B
C
AC IN  
FM  
GND  
AM  
Y
P
B
PB  
VIDEO  
SPEAKERS  
IN  
OUT  
(REC)  
SP1  
PRESENCE  
(PLAY)  
+
+
R
L
WRENCH  
HOLDER  
MD/  
TAPE  
PR  
L
PR  
IN  
OUT  
REMOTE  
R
SURROUND BACK/  
BI-AMP  
CENTER  
+
+
+
HDMI  
SINGLE  
CENTER FRONT(6CH) SURROUND  
CENTER  
SURROUND SINGLE(SB)  
ZONE 2  
FRONT  
GND  
PHONO  
CD  
CD-R  
IN 2  
L
AC OUTLETS  
CBL/  
SAT  
R
+
+
SURROUND  
+
+
L
R
R
IN (PLAY)  
SUB  
WOOFER  
MULTI CH INPUT  
SUB  
SUR.BACK/  
PRESENCE  
OUT(REC)  
ZONE  
OUT  
SB(8CH)  
WOOFER  
IN 1  
AUDIO  
XM  
PRE OUT  
DIGITAL INPUT  
DIGITAL OUTPUT  
DOCK  
DVD  
OUT  
FRONT  
L
COAXIAL  
OPTICAL  
DVR/  
CBL/  
SAT  
TMADPE/  
1
CD  
2
DVD  
3
CD  
5
DVD  
6
DTV  
8
9
CD-R  
7
4
VCR2  
8
9
0
A
B
CENTER FRONT(6CH) SURROUND  
CENTER  
SURROUND SINGLE(SB)  
ZONE 2  
FRONT  
SUB  
WOOFER  
SUB  
WOOFER  
SUR.BACK/  
PRESENCE  
ZONE  
OUT  
SB(8CH)  
MULTI CH INPUT  
PRE OUT  
C
D
E
1 REMOTE jacks  
8 HDMI connectors  
See page 112 for details.  
See page 18 for connection information.  
2 COMPONENT VIDEO jacks  
9 DOCK terminal  
See pages 20 and 21 for connection information.  
See page 26 for connection information.  
3 Audio component jacks  
0 XM jack  
See page 23 for connection information.  
See page 60 for connection information.  
4 Video component jacks  
A DIGITAL INPUT/OUTPUT jacks  
See pages 20 and 21 for connection information.  
See page 21 for connection information.  
5 ANTENNA terminals  
B Speaker terminals  
See page 27 for connection information.  
See page 13 for connection information.  
6 WRENCH HOLDER  
C MULTI CH INPUT jacks  
Use to hook the supplied speaker terminal wrench when  
not in use (see page 14).  
See page 25 for connection information.  
D PRE OUT jacks  
7 AC IN/OUTLET(S)  
See page 24 for connection information.  
See page 28 for connection information.  
E ZONE OUT jacks  
See page 112 for connection information.  
11 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
CONNECTIONS  
Placing speakers  
The speaker layout below shows the speaker setting we  
recommend. You can use it to enjoy CINEMA DSP and  
multi-channel audio sources.  
Front left and right speakers (FL and FR)  
The front speakers are used for the main source sound plus  
effect sounds. Place these speakers at an equal distance from  
the ideal listening position. The distance of each speaker  
from each side of the video monitor should be the same.  
PL  
PR  
C
FL  
FR  
Center speaker (C)  
The center speaker is for the center channel sounds  
(dialog, vocals, etc.). If for some reason it is not practical  
to use a center speaker, you can do without it. Best results,  
however, are obtained with the full system. Place the  
center speaker centrally between the front speakers and as  
close to the monitor as possible, such as directly over or  
under it.  
30˚  
SL  
SL  
SR  
SR  
60˚  
80˚  
Surround left and right speakers (SL and SR)  
The surround speakers are used for effect and surround  
sounds. Place these speakers behind your listening  
position, facing slightly inwards, about 1.8 m (6 ft) above  
the floor.  
SBL  
SBR  
30 cm (12 in) or more  
Surround back left and right speakers (SBL and  
SBR)  
PR  
FR  
SL  
The surround back speakers supplement the surround  
speakers and provide more realistic front-to-back  
transitions. Place these speakers directly behind the  
listening position and at the same height as the surround  
speakers. They should be positioned at least 30 cm (12 in)  
apart. Ideally, they should be positioned at the same width  
as that of the front speakers.  
PL  
SW  
SR  
SBR  
FL  
C
SBL  
Presence left and right speakers (PL and PR)  
The presence speakers supplement the sound from the front  
speakers with extra ambient effects produced by CINEMA  
DSP (see page 134). These effects include sounds that  
filmmakers intend to locate a little farther back behind the  
screen in order to create more theater-like ambience. Place  
these speakers at the front of the room about 0.5 to 1 m (1  
to 3 ft) outside the front speakers, facing slightly inward,  
and about 1.8 m (6 ft) above the floor.  
1.8 m (6 ft)  
0.5 to 1 m (1 to 3 ft)  
PL  
0.5 to 1 m (1 to 3 ft)  
PR  
Subwoofer (SW)  
The use of a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier, such as  
the YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer  
System, is effective not only for reinforcing bass  
frequencies from any or all channels, but also for high  
fidelity sound reproduction of the LFE (low-frequency  
effect) channel included in Dolby Digital and DTS  
sources. The position of the subwoofer is not so critical,  
because low bass sounds are not highly directional. But it  
is better to place the subwoofer near the front speakers.  
Turn it slightly toward the center of the room to reduce  
wall reflections.  
FL  
FR  
C
1.8 m (6 ft)  
12 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting speakers  
Be sure to connect the left channel (L), right channel (R), “+” (red) and “–” (black) properly. If the connections are faulty,  
no sound will be heard from the speakers, and if the polarity of the speaker connections is incorrect, the sound will be  
unnatural and lack bass.  
CAUTION  
Before connecting the speakers, make sure that this unit is turned off (see page 30).  
Do not let the bare speaker wires touch each other or do not let them touch any metal part of this  
unit. This could damage this unit and/or speakers.  
Use magnetically shielded speakers. If this type of speaker still creates interference with the  
monitor, place the speakers away from the monitor.  
If you are to use 6 ohm speakers, be sure to set “SP IMP.” to “6MIN” before using this unit (see  
page 29). 4 ohm speakers can be also used as the front speakers (see page 118).  
Notes  
• A speaker cord is actually a pair of insulated cables running side by side. Cables are colored or shaped differently, perhaps with a  
stripe, groove or ridge. Connect the striped (grooved, etc.) cable to the “+” (red) terminals of this unit and your speaker. Connect the  
plain cable to the “–” (black) terminals.  
• The low-frequency signals of other speakers set to “SML” (or “SMALL”) or to “NONE” in “SPEAKER SET” (see pages 86 and 88)  
are directed to the speakers selected in “LFE/BASS OUT” (see page 86).  
You can connect both surround back and presence speakers to this unit, however they do not output sound simultaneously. You can set  
to prioritize either set of speakers using the “PRIORITY” parameter in “MANUAL SETUP” (see page 88).  
You can use the PRESENCE terminals to connect the Zone 2 speakers as well as the presence speakers (see page 112).  
Presence speakers  
Surround back speakers  
Subwoofer  
Right  
Left  
Left  
Right  
Center speaker  
SPEAKERS  
SP1  
PRESENCE  
+
L
R
SURROUND BACK/  
BI-AMP  
CENTER  
+
+
+
SINGLE  
SURROUND  
+
+
+
+
L
L
R
R
SUB  
WOOFER  
PRE OUT  
FRONT  
Right  
Left  
Surround speakers  
Right  
Left  
Front speakers  
13 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
FRONT terminals  
Connect front left and right speakers to these terminals.  
Connecting the speaker cable  
CENTER terminals  
Connect a center speaker to these terminals.  
1
Remove approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) of  
insulation from the end of each speaker  
cable and then twist the exposed wires of the  
cable together to prevent short circuits.  
SURROUND terminals  
Connect surround left and right speakers to these  
terminals.  
SURROUND BACK terminals  
Connect surround back left and right speakers to these  
terminals.  
10 mm (0.4 in)  
Note  
When you use a surround back speaker, connect the speaker to the  
left SURROUND BACK terminal (SINGLE).  
2
Loosen the knob using the supplied speaker  
terminal wrench.  
PRESENCE terminals  
Connect presence left and right speakers to these  
terminals.  
Speaker terminal wrench  
SUBWOOFER jack  
Connect a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier (such as the  
YAMAHA Active Servo Processing Subwoofer System)  
to this jack.  
Red: positive (+)  
Black: negative (–)  
3
4
Insert one bare wire into the hole on the side  
of each terminal.  
Tighten the knob to secure the wire using the  
supplied speaker terminal wrench.  
14 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
5
Hook the speaker terminal wrench onto the  
WRENCH HOLDER on the rear panel of this  
unit when not in use.  
Connecting the banana plug  
The banana plug is a single-pole electrical connector  
widely used to terminate speaker cables.  
Banana plug  
1
Tighten the knob using the supplied speaker  
terminal wrench.  
Speaker terminal wrench  
Red: positive (+)  
Black: negative (–)  
2
Insert the banana plug connector into the  
end of the corresponding terminal.  
15 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
W
Using bi-amplification connections  
Some of the speakers have speaker wire connections that  
allow bi-amplification to enhance the performance of the  
speaker system. This unit allows you to make bi-  
amplification connection to one speaker system. Check if  
your speakers support bi-amplification. As these speakers  
are shipped to you, you will note shorting bars or bridges,  
one connecting the two red input terminals and the other  
connecting the two black input terminals. Remove these  
shorting bars or bridges only if you plan to bi-amplify  
your speakers.  
Bi-amplification connection  
To make the bi-amplification connections, use the FRONT  
and SURROUND BACK terminals as shown below. To  
activate the bi-amplification connections, set “BI-AMP”  
to “ON” in “ADVANCED SETUP” (see page 119).  
This unit  
SURROUND BACK/  
+
+
+
+
BI-AMP  
SINGLE  
Conventional connection  
If you want to connect your speakers as traditional  
loudspeakers using the conventional connection method,  
connect your speakers using the regular left and right  
speaker wire connections and ignore the second set of  
terminals.  
FRONT  
L
R
This unit  
+
FRONT  
+
L
R
Left  
Right  
Front speakers  
Note  
Remove the shorting bars or bridges to separate the LPF (low  
pass filter) and HPF (high pass filter) crossovers.  
Right  
Left  
Front speakers  
Shorting bars or  
bridges  
Shorting bars or  
bridges  
16 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Information on jacks and cable plugs  
Audio jacks and cable plugs  
Video jacks and cable plugs  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
DIGITAL  
DIGITAL  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
S VIDEO  
Y
PB  
PR  
L
R
COAXIAL  
OPTICAL  
(White)  
(Red)  
(Orange)  
(Yellow)  
(Green) (Blue) (Red)  
S
O
V
PB  
PR  
Y
L
R
C
Left and right  
analog audio digital audio  
cable plugs  
Coaxial  
Optical  
digital  
audio cable  
plug  
Composite  
video cable  
plug  
S-video  
cable plug  
Component  
video cable  
plugs  
cable plug  
Audio jacks  
Video jacks  
This unit has three types of audio jacks. Connection  
depends on the availability of audio jacks on your other  
components.  
This unit has three types of video jacks. Connection  
depends on the availability of input jacks on your video  
monitor.  
AUDIO jacks  
VIDEO jacks  
For conventional analog audio signals transmitted via left  
and right analog audio cables. Connect red plugs to the  
right jacks and white plugs to the left jacks.  
For conventional composite video signals transmitted via  
composite video cables.  
S VIDEO jacks  
DIGITAL COAXIAL jacks  
For digital audio signals transmitted via coaxial digital  
audio cables.  
For S-video signals, separated into the luminance (Y) and  
chrominance (C) video signals transmitted on separate  
wires of S-video cables.  
DIGITAL OPTICAL jacks  
COMPONENT VIDEO jacks  
For digital audio signals transmitted via optical digital  
audio cables.  
For component video signals, separated into the  
luminance (Y) and chrominance (PB, PR) video signals  
transmitted on separate wires of component video cables.  
Note  
y
You can use the digital jacks to input PCM, Dolby Digital and  
DTS bitstreams. When you connect components to both the  
COAXIAL and OPTICAL jacks, priority is given to the signals  
input at the COAXIAL jack. All digital input jacks are  
compatible with 96-kHz sampling digital signals.  
This unit equips the video connection function. See pages 19 and  
96 for details.  
17 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Information on HDMI  
This unit has the HDMI IN 1, HDMI IN 2 and HDMI OUT jacks for digital audio and video signal input/output. Connect  
the HDMI IN 1 or HDMI IN 2 jack of this unit to the HDMI output jack of other HDMI components (such as a DVD  
player). Connect the HDMI OUT jack of this unit to the HDMI IN jack of other HDMI components (such as a TV and a  
projector).  
The video or audio signals input at the HDMI IN 1 or HDMI IN 2 jack of the selected input source are output at the  
HDMI OUT jack of this unit.  
Note  
You can check the potential problem about the HDMI connection (see page 41).  
HDMI compatibility with this unit  
HDMI jack and cable plug  
Compatible  
HDMI  
components  
Audio signal  
types  
Audio signal  
formats  
HDMI  
2ch Linear PCM  
2ch, 32-192 kHz,  
16/20/24 bit  
CD, DVD-Video,  
DVD-Audio, etc.  
Multi-ch Linear  
PCM  
8ch, 32-192 kHz,  
16/20/24 bit  
DVD-Audio, etc.  
DSD  
2/5.1ch, 2.8224  
MHz, 1 bit  
SACD, etc.  
Bitstream  
Dolby Digital, DTS DVD-Video, etc.  
This unit’s HDMI interface is based on the following  
standards:  
HDMI cable plug  
HDMI Version 1.2a (High-Definition Multimedia  
Interface Specification Version 1.2a) licensed by  
HDMI Licensing, LLC.  
HDCP Revision 1.1 (High-bandwidth Digital  
Content Protection System Revision 1.1) licensed  
by Digital Content Protection, LLC.  
y
• We recommend using an HDMI cable shorter than 5 meters (16  
feet) with the HDMI logo printed on it.  
• Use a conversion cable (HDMI jack DVI-D jack) to connect  
this unit to other DVI components.  
Notes  
• Do not disconnect or connect the cable or turn off the power of  
the HDMI components connected to the HDMI OUT jack of  
this unit while data is being transferred. Doing so may disrupt  
playback or cause noise.  
• Audio signals input at input jacks other than the HDMI IN 1 or  
HDMI IN 2 of this unit cannot be digitally output at the HDMI  
OUT jack.  
Notes  
• When CPPM copy-protected DVD audio is played back, video  
and audio signals may not be output depending on the type of  
the DVD player.  
• This unit is not compatible with HDCP-incompatible HDMI or  
DVI components.  
• If you turn off the power of the video monitor connected to the  
HDMI OUT jack via a DVI connection, this unit may fail to  
establish the connection to the component.  
• The analog video signals input at the composite video, S-video  
and component video jacks can be digitally up-converted to be  
output at the HDMI OUT jack. Set “V CONV.” to “ON” in  
“MANUAL SETUP” (see page 97) to activate this feature.  
18 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Audio and video signal flow  
Audio signal flow  
Video signal flow  
Input  
Output  
Input  
Output  
HDMI  
HDMI  
DIGITAL AUDIO  
(COAXIAL)  
COMPONENT  
VIDEO  
DIGITAL AUDIO  
(OPTICAL)  
S VIDEO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
Digital output  
Analog output  
Through  
Video conversion (see page 96)  
Notes  
Component interlace/progressive up-  
conversion (see page 97)  
• 2-channel as well as multi-channel PCM, Dolby Digital and  
DTS signals input at the HDMI IN 1 or HDMI IN 2 jack can be  
output at the HDMI OUT jack only when “SUPPORT AUDIO”  
is set to “OTHER” (see page 92).  
HDMI interlace/progressive up-  
conversion (see page 97)  
• Audio signals input at the HDMI IN jacks are not output at the  
analog AUDIO OUT and DIGITAL OUTPUT jacks.  
Notes  
• When the analog video signals are input at the COMPONENT  
VIDEO, S VIDEO and VIDEO jacks, the priority order of the  
input signals is as follows:  
1. COMPONENT VIDEO  
2. S VIDEO  
3. VIDEO  
• The analog video signals output at the COMPONENT VIDEO  
jacks can be deinterlaced from 480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) to  
480p (NTSC)/576p(PAL). Set “CMPNT I/P” to “ON” in  
“MANUAL SETUP” to activate this feature (see page 97).  
• Digital video signals input at the HDMI IN 1 or HDMI IN 2  
jack cannot be output from analog video output jacks.  
• The analog component video signals with  
480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) of resolution are converted to the s-  
video or composite video signals and output at the S VIDEO  
MONITOR OUT and VIDEO MONITOR OUT jacks.  
• Component interlace/progressive conversion (see page 97) and  
HDMI interlace/progressive up-conversion (see page 97) are  
available only when “V CONV.” is set to “ON” (see page 96).  
• Use the “HDMI I/P” parameter in “OPTION MENU” to  
deinterlace the analog video signals output at the HDMI OUT  
jack (see page 97). When the analog video signals with 1080i or  
720p of resolution are up-converted to HDMI and output at the  
HDMI OUT jack, the picture quality may worsen.  
• The OSD signal is not output at the VCR 1 OUT and  
DVR/VCR 2 OUT jacks and is not recorded.  
• The color of the letters and images in the OSD may differ  
depending on the input signals and your video monitor.  
19 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting a TV monitor or projector  
Connect your TV (or projector) to the HDMI OUT jack, the COMPONENT VIDEO MONITOR OUT jacks, the S  
VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack or the VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack of this unit.  
CAUTION  
Do not connect this unit or other components to the AC power supply until all connections between  
components are complete.  
y
You can select to play back HDMI audio signals on this unit or on another HDMI component connected to the HDMI OUT jack on the  
rear panel of this unit. Use the “SUPPORT AUDIO” parameter in “SOUND MENU” to select the component to play back HDMI audio  
signals (see page 92).  
Notes  
• Some video monitors connected to this unit via a DVI connection fail to recognize the HDMI audio/video signals being input if they  
are in the standby mode. In this case, the HDMI indicator flashes irregularly.  
• Set “V CONV.” in “OPTION MENU” to “ON” (see page 96) to display the short message display and parameter displays.  
• Set “GRAY BACK” in “OPTION MENU” to “ON” (see page 96) to display the parameter displays.  
• The SET MENU and parameter displays appear with the gray background depending on the input video signal format and the setting  
of the parameters in “DISPLAY SET” (see page 96).  
COMPONENTVIDEO  
MONITOR OUT  
Y
MONITOR OUT  
SVIDEO  
VIDEO  
PB  
PR  
HDMI  
OUT  
S
V
Y
PB  
PR  
Component video in  
HDMI in  
Video in  
S-video in  
TV (or projector)  
indicates recommended connections  
indicates alternative connections  
20 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting other components  
CAUTION  
Do not connect this unit or other components to the AC power supply until all connections between  
components are complete.  
Notes  
• When “V CONV.” is set to “OFF” (see page 96), be sure to make the same type of video connections as those made for your TV (see  
page 20). For example, if you connected your TV to the VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack of this unit, connect your other components to  
the VIDEO jacks.  
• When “V CONV.” is set to “ON” (see page 96), the converted video signals are output only at the MONITOR OUT jacks. When  
recording a source, you must make the same type of video connections between each component.  
• To make a digital connection to a component other than the default component assigned to each DIGITAL INPUT or DIGITAL  
OUTPUT jack, select the corresponding setting for “OPTICAL OUT”, “OPTICAL IN”, or “COAXIAL IN” in “I/O ASSIGNMENT”  
(see page 93).  
• If you connect your DVD player to both the DIGITAL INPUT (OPTICAL) and the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jacks, priority is  
given to the signals input at the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack.  
• The parameter displays do not appear when the component video signals with 720p, 1080i or 1080p are input.  
• The parameter and short message displays do not appear when the component video signals with 480p/576p, 720p, 1080i or 1080p  
resolutions are input and output at the VIDEO or S VIDEO MONITOR OUT jack.  
Connecting a DVD player  
DVD player  
Optical out  
HDMI out  
Coaxial out  
Audio out  
Component out  
S-video out  
Video out  
C
R
L
PR  
PB  
Y
V
O
S
COMPONENTVIDEO  
VIDEO  
DVD  
DVD  
A
Y
P
B
PR  
L
R
HDMI  
IN 1  
DIGITAL INPUT  
COAXIAL  
DVD  
OPTICAL  
DVD  
2
DVD  
5
indicates recommended connections  
indicates alternative connections  
21 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting a DVD recorder, PVR or VCR  
Note  
*1 When you connect another VCR to this unit, connect it to the VCR 1 terminals (S VIDEO IN, VIDEO IN, AUDIO IN, S VIDEO  
OUT, VIDEO OUT and AUDIO OUT jacks) same as DVR/VCR 2 terminals except the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack.  
*1  
VIDEO  
IN  
VCR 1  
OUT IN DVR/VCR 2 OUT  
SVIDEO  
VIDEO  
L
R
IN DVR/VCR 2 OUT  
DIGITAL INPUT  
COAXIAL  
DVR/  
3
VCR2  
S
S
V
V
L
R
R
L
C
DVD recorder, PVR or VCR  
Connecting set-top boxes  
Satellite receiver, cable TV  
receiver  
HDTV decoder  
HDMI out  
Component out  
Optical out  
R
L
L
R
PR  
PB  
Y
V
S
V
PR  
PB  
Y
O
O
S
COMPONENTVIDEO  
VIDEO  
CBL/SAT  
DTV  
CBL/SAT  
DTV  
B
C
Y
SVIDEO  
VIDEO  
P
B
PR  
L
R
HDMI  
IN 2  
CBL/  
SAT  
DIGITAL INPUT  
OPTICAL  
CBL/  
SAT  
DTV  
7
6
22 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting audio components  
Notes  
• To make a digital connection to a component other than the default component assigned to each the DIGITAL INPUT jack or the  
DIGITAL OUTPUT jack, select the corresponding setting for “OPTICAL OUT”, “OPTICAL IN”, or “COAXIAL IN” in “I/O  
ASSIGNMENT” (see page 93).  
• Connect your turntable to the GND terminal of this unit to reduce noise in the signal. However, you may hear less noise without the  
connection to the GND terminal for some turntables.  
• The PHONO jacks are only compatible with a turntable with an MM or a high-output MC cartridge. To connect a turntable with a low-  
output MC cartridge to the PHONO jacks, use an in-line boosting transformer or an MC-head amplifier.  
• When you connect both the DIGITAL INPUT (OPTICAL) jack and the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack to an audio component,  
the priority is given to the DIGITAL INPUT (COAXIAL) jack.  
Audio out  
Audio in  
Optical in  
L
O
R
L
CD recorder  
R
IN  
OUT  
(REC)  
(PLAY)  
MD/  
L
TAPE  
R
CD  
GND  
PHONO  
CD-R  
L
R
IN(PLAY)  
OUT(REC)  
AUDIO  
DIGITAL OUTPUT  
DIGITAL INPUT  
COAXIAL  
OPTICAL  
TMADPE/  
CD-R  
1
CD  
CD  
8
9
4
O
O
R
L
R
L
C
R
L
R
L
Ground  
Coaxial  
out  
Optical  
out  
Audio out  
Audio  
out  
Audio  
in  
Audio  
out  
Optical in  
CD player  
MD recorder or tape  
deck  
Turntable  
23 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting an external amplifier  
This unit has more than enough power for any home use.  
However, if you want to add more power to the speaker  
output or if you want to use another amplifier, connect an  
external amplifier to the PRE OUT jacks.  
Notes  
• When you make connections to the PRE OUT jacks, do not  
make connections to the SPEAKERS terminals.  
• The signals output at the FRONT PRE OUT and CENTER PRE  
OUT jacks are affected by the TONE CONTROL settings (see  
page 49).  
• Each PRE OUT jack outputs the same channel signals as the  
corresponding SPEAKERS terminals.  
• Adjust the volume level of the subwoofer with the control on  
the subwoofer (see page 50).  
• Some signals may not be output at the SUBWOOFER PRE  
OUT jack depending on the settings for “SPEAKER SET” (see  
page 86) and “LFE/BASS OUT” (see page 86).  
1
2
3
4
SURROUND SINGLE(SB)  
CENTER  
FRONT  
L
R
SUR.BACK/  
PRESENCE  
SUB  
WOOFER  
PRE OUT  
5
1 CENTER PRE OUT jack  
Center channel output jack.  
2 FRONT PRE OUT jacks  
Front channel output jacks.  
3 SURROUND PRE OUT jacks  
Surround channel output jacks.  
4 SURROUND BACK/PRESENCE PRE OUT  
jacks  
Surround back or presence channel output jacks. When  
you only connect one external amplifier for the surround  
back channel, connect it to the SINGLE (SB) jack.  
y
• Set the “SB L/R SP” to “LRGx2”, “LRGx1”, “SMLx2” or  
“SMLx1” and “PRESENCE SP” to “NONE” (see page 88) to  
output the surround back channel signals at SURROUND  
BACK/PRESENCE PRE OUT jacks.  
• Set the “PRESENCE SP” to “YES” and “SB L/R SP” to  
“NONE” (see page 88) to output the presence channel signals at  
SURROUND BACK/PRESENCE PRE OUT jacks.  
5 SUBWOOFER PRE OUT jack  
Connect a subwoofer with a built-in amplifier.  
24 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting a multi-format player or an external decoder  
This unit is equipped with 6 additional input jacks (left and right FRONT, CENTER, left and right SURROUND and  
SUBWOOFER) for discrete multi-channel input from a multi-format player, external decoder, sound processor or pre-  
amplifier.  
If you set “INPUT CH” to “8ch” in “MULTI CH SET” (see page 95), you can use the input jacks assigned as “FRONT”  
in “MULTI CH SET” (see page 95) together with the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to input 8-channel signals.  
Connect the output jacks on your multi-format player or external decoder to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks. Be sure to  
match the left and right outputs to the left and right input jacks for the front and surround channels.  
Notes  
• When you select the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks as the input source (see page 40), this unit automatically  
turns off the digital sound field processor, and you cannot select sound field programs.  
• This unit does not redirect signals input at the MULTI CH INPUT jacks to accommodate for missing speakers. We recommend that  
you connect at least a 5.1-channel speaker system before using this feature.  
For 6-channel input  
For 8-channel input  
CENTER FRONT(6CH) SURROUND  
L
MD/  
TAPE  
L
*1  
R
R
CENTER FRONT(6CH) SURROUND  
SUB  
SB(8CH)  
WOOFER  
L
MULTI CH INPUT  
R
L
R
L
R
SUB  
WOOFER  
SUB  
SB(8CH)  
MULTI CH INPUT  
L
R
L
R
L
R
Multi-format player/External  
decoder  
Multi-format player/External  
decoder  
Note  
*1 The analog audio input jacks assigned as “FRONT” in  
“MULTI CH SET” (see page 95).  
25 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting a YAMAHA iPod  
universal dock  
Using the VIDEO AUX jacks on the  
front panel  
This unit is equipped with the DOCK terminal on the rear  
panel that allows you to connect a YAMAHA iPod  
universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold separately)  
where you can station your iPod and control playback of  
your iPod using the supplied remote control. Connect a  
YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold  
separately) to the DOCK terminal on the rear panel of this  
unit using its dedicated cable.  
Use the VIDEO AUX jacks on the front panel to connect a  
game console or a video camera to this unit.  
CAUTION  
Be sure to turn off the volume of this unit and  
other components before making connections.  
Note  
CAUTION  
The audio signals input at the DOCK terminal on the rear panel  
take priority over the ones input at the VIDEO AUX jacks.  
Do not connect this unit to the AC power supply  
until all connections between components are  
complete.  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
VIDEO  
L
OPTICAL  
S VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
DOCK  
S
V
O
L
R
YAMAHA iPod universal dock  
(such as the YDS-10, sold  
separately)  
S-Video  
output  
Video Audio Optical  
output output output  
Game console or  
video camera  
26 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting the FM and AM antennas  
Both FM and AM indoor antennas are supplied with this  
unit. Connect each antenna correctly to the designated  
terminals. In general, these antennas should provide  
sufficient signal strength.  
2
3
Press and hold the tab of the AM ANT  
terminal.  
Notes  
• The AM loop antenna should be placed away from this unit.  
• The AM loop antenna should always be connected, even if an  
outdoor AM antenna is connected to this unit.  
• A properly installed outdoor antenna provides clearer reception  
than an indoor one. If you experience poor reception quality,  
install an outdoor antenna. Consult the nearest authorized  
YAMAHA dealer or service center about outdoor antennas.  
Insert one of the AM loop antenna lead wires  
into the AM ANT terminal.  
Indoor FM  
antenna  
(supplied)  
AM loop  
antenna  
(supplied)  
ANTENNA  
GND AM  
FM  
4
5
Release the tab of the AM ANT terminal.  
Outdoor AM antenna  
Use a 5 to 10 m (16.4 to 32.8  
ft) vinyl-covered wire  
extended outdoors from a  
window.  
Ground (GND terminal)  
For maximum safety and minimum interference, connect the  
antenna GND terminal to a good earth ground. A good earth  
ground is a metal stake driven into moist earth.  
Repeat steps 2 through 4 to connect the  
other lead wire to the GND terminal.  
Connecting the AM loop antenna  
y
Once you have properly connected the AM loop antenna to  
this unit, orient the AM loop antenna for the best reception  
when you tune into AM stations (see page 53).  
1
Set up the AM loop antenna.  
27 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Connecting the power cable  
Connecting the AC power cable  
CAUTION  
Use the supplied AC cable. Do not use other AC power cables as doing so may result in fire or  
electrical shock.  
Plug the supplied AC power cable into the AC inlet after all other connections are complete, then plug the AC power  
cable into an AC wall outlet.  
AC IN  
To the AC wall outlet  
AC OUTLETS  
AC OUTLETS (SWITCHED)  
Use these 2 outlets to supply power to any connected  
components. Connect the power cable of your other  
components to these 2 outlets. Power to these 2 outlets is  
supplied when this unit is turned on. However, power to  
these 2 outlets is cut off when this unit is turned off. For  
information on the maximum power or the total power  
consumption of the components that can be connected to  
these 2 outlets, see “SPECIFICATIONS” on page 136.  
Memory back-up  
The memory back-up circuit prevents the stored data  
from being lost even if this unit is in the standby mode.  
However, the stored data will be lost in case the power  
cable is disconnected from the AC wall outlet or if the  
power supply is cut off for more than one week.  
28 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Setting the speaker impedance  
CAUTION  
4
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel  
repeatedly to select “6MIN”.  
The following display appears in the front panel  
display.  
If you are to use 6 ohm speakers, set “SPEAKER  
IMP.” to “6MIN” as follows BEFORE using this  
unit. 4 ohm speakers can be also used as the  
front speakers.  
EFFECT  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
SPEAKER IMP.  
6
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
MIN  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
5
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to save  
the new setting and turn off this unit.  
2,5  
2,4 3  
1
2
Make sure this unit is turned off.  
See page 30 for details about turning on or off this  
unit.  
MASTER  
Press and hold STRAIGHT on the front panel  
and then press MASTER ON/OFF inward to  
the ON position to turn on this unit.  
This unit turns on, and the advanced setup menu  
appears in the front panel display.  
Note  
The setting you made is reflected next time you turn on this  
unit.  
While holding  
STRAIGHT  
down  
EFFECT  
MASTER  
3
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front  
panel to select “SPEAKER IMP.”.  
The following display appears in the front panel  
display.  
PROGRAM  
SPEAKER IMP.  
8
MIN  
29 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONNECTIONS  
Turning on and off the power  
When all connections are complete, turn on this unit.  
MAIN ZONE ON/OFF  
STANDBY  
POWER  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
PHONO  
TUNER  
MULTI CH IN  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
MASTER ON/OFF  
Turning on this unit  
Turning on the main zone from the  
standby mode  
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel  
inward to the ON position to turn on this  
unit.  
Press MAIN ZONE ON/OFF on the front  
panel (or POWER on the remote control) to  
turn on the main zone.  
MAIN ZONE  
When you turns on this unit by pressing MASTER ON/  
OFF, the main zone is turned on.  
POWER  
or  
ON/OFF  
MASTER  
Front panel  
Front panel  
Remote control  
Turning off this unit  
Set the main zone to the standby mode  
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel  
again to release it outward to the OFF  
position to turn off this unit.  
Press MAIN ZONE ON/OFF on the front  
panel (or STANDBY on the remote control)  
to set the main zone to the standby mode.  
MAIN ZONE  
MASTER  
STANDBY  
or  
Front panel  
ON/OFF  
Notes  
Front panel  
Remote control  
• MAIN ZONE ON/OFF on the front panel as well as POWER  
and STANDBY on the remote control are operational only  
when MASTER ON/OFF is pressed inward to the ON position.  
• As usual, we recommend using the standby mode to turn off this  
unit.  
30 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO SETUP  
AUTO SETUP  
This unit employs the YPAO (YAMAHA Parametric Room Acoustic Optimizer) technology which lets you avoid  
troublesome listening-based speaker setup and achieves highly accurate sound adjustments automatically. The supplied  
optimizer microphone collects and this unit analyzes the sound your speakers produce in your actual listening  
environment.  
Using AUTO SETUP  
1
Connect the supplied optimizer microphone  
to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front  
panel.  
Once you have connected the supplied optimizer  
microphone to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front  
panel and have placed it in a suitable location in your  
listening room, run “AUTO SETUP” in the OSD or in the  
front panel display.  
ON  
OFF  
MASTER  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PHNES  
Notes  
SILENT CINEMA  
• Be advised that it is normal for loud test tones to be output  
during the “AUTO SETUP” procedure.  
• To achieve the best results, make sure the room is as quiet as  
possible while the “AUTO SETUP” procedure is in progress. If  
there is too much ambient noise, the results may not be  
satisfactory.  
Omni-directional  
microphone  
y
You can run “AUTO SETUP” using the system menu that  
appears in the OSD or in the front panel display. This manual  
uses the OSD illustrations to explain the “AUTO SETUP”  
procedure.  
2
Place the optimizer microphone at your  
normal listening position on a flat level  
surface with the omni-directional  
microphone heading upward.  
• If an error occurs during the “AUTO SETUP” procedure and an  
error or warning message appears in the OSD or in the front  
panel display, see the “AUTO SETUP” section in  
“TROUBLESHOOTING” on pages 128 and 129 for a complete  
list of error and warning messages and proper remedies.  
• The initial setting for each parameter is indicated in bold.  
• If the volume level and the crossover frequency of your  
subwoofer can be adjusted, set the volume level to about half  
way (or slightly less) and set the crossover frequency to the  
maximum.  
Optimizer microphone  
AMP  
4
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
SOURCE  
TV  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
4,14  
3-13  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
y
XM MEMORY  
It is recommended that you use a tripod (etc.) to affix the  
optimizer microphone at the same height as your ears would be  
when you are seated in your listening position. You can use a 6  
mm diameter screw to fix the optimizer microphone to a tripod  
(etc.).  
31 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO SETUP  
3
Make sure of the following check points  
7
Press k/ nrepeatedly to select “WIRING”,  
“DISTANCE”, “SIZE”, “EQ”, or “LEVEL”.  
before starting the AUTO SETUP operations.  
• Speakers are connected appropriately.  
• Supplied optimizer microphone is connected to this  
unit and placed appropriately.  
• Headphones are disconnected from this unit.  
• The room is sufficiently quiet.  
PRESET/CH  
1 A TO:MENU  
ꢀSETUP;;;;;;;AUTO  
.ꢀWIRING;;;;;CHECK  
ꢀꢀDISTANCE;;;CHECK  
ꢀꢀSIZE;;;;;;;CHECK  
ENTER  
ꢀꢀEQ;;;;;;;NATURAL  
ꢀꢀLEVEL;;;;;;CHECKꢀ  
ꢀꢀSTART  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
A-E/CAT.  
• The video monitor connected to this unit is turned on.  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Select  
p
[
4
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU to enter “SET MENU”.  
The top “SET MENU” display appears in the OSD.  
This unit performs the following checks:  
Speaker wiring WIRING  
Checks which speakers are connected and the  
polarity of each speaker.  
AMP  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
Speaker distance DISTANCE  
Checks the distance of each speaker from the  
listening position and adjusts the timing of each  
channel.  
TV  
ꢀꢀSET MENU  
.;AUTOꢀSETUP  
;MANUALꢀSETUP  
.;SIGNALꢀINFO  
Speaker size SIZE  
ꢀꢀ[ ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
Checks the frequency response of each speaker and  
sets the appropriate low-frequency crossover for each  
channel.  
Choices: CHECK, SKIP  
• Select “CHECK” to automatically check and adjust  
the item.  
• Select “SKIP” to skip the item and perform no  
adjustments.  
5
6
Press ENTER to enter “AUTO SETUP”.  
The “AUTO:MENU” display appears in the OSD.  
PRESET/CH  
1 A TO:MENU  
.ꢀSETUP;;;;;;;AUTO  
ꢀWIRING;;;;;CHECK  
ꢀꢀDISTANCE;;;CHECK  
Parametric equalizer level EQ  
ꢀꢀSIZE;;;;;;;CHECK  
ꢀꢀEQ;;;;;;;NATURAL  
ꢀꢀLEVEL;;;;;;CHECKꢀ  
ENTER  
Adjusts the frequency and the parametric equalizer  
level of each channel to reduce coloration across the  
channels and create a cohesive sound field. This is  
particularly important if you use different brands or  
sizes of speakers for some channels or have a room  
with unique sonic characteristics. In addition, the  
frequency response of each channel is adjusted in  
accordance with the sound output from your front  
speakers.  
A-E/CAT.  
ꢀꢀSTART  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Select  
p
[
Press l/ hto select “SETUP”.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
Choices: NATURAL, FLAT, FRONT, SKIP  
• Select “NATURAL” to average out the frequency  
response of all speakers with higher frequencies  
being less emphasized. Recommended if the FLAT  
setting sounds a little harsh.  
• Select “FLAT” to average the frequency response  
of all speakers. Recommended if all of your  
speakers are of similar quality.  
• Select “FRONT” to adjust the frequency response  
of each speaker in accordance with the sound of  
your front speakers. Recommended if your front  
speakers are of much higher quality than your other  
speakers.  
A-E/CAT.  
Choices: AUTO, RELOAD  
• Select “AUTO” to automatically run the entire  
“AUTO SETUP” procedure.  
• Select “RELOAD” to reload the last “AUTO  
SETUP” settings and override the previous  
settings. When you select “RELOAD”, the  
previous auto setup result appears in the OSD. See  
step 7 on page 33 and carry out the operations.  
Note  
• Select “SKIP” to skip the selected item and  
perform no adjustments.  
“RELOAD” is available only when you have previously run  
“AUTO SETUP” and confirmed the results.  
32 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO SETUP  
Volume level LEVEL  
The results displayed under “RESULT” are as  
Checks and adjusts the volume level of each speaker.  
follows.  
Choices: CHECK, SKIP  
• Select “CHECK” to automatically check and adjust  
this item.  
• Select “SKIP” to skip this item and perform no  
adjustments.  
Number of speakers SP  
Displays the number of speakers connected to this  
unit in the following order:  
Front/Back/Subwoofer  
Speaker distance DIST  
Displays the speaker distance from the listening  
position in the following order:  
Closest speaker distance/Farthest speaker distance  
8
Press nto select “START” and then press  
ENTER to start the setup procedure.  
This unit starts the auto setup procedure. Loud test  
tones are output from each speaker during the auto  
setup procedure. Once all items are set, the  
“RESULT:EXIT” display appears in the OSD.  
Speaker level LVL  
Displays the speaker output level in the following  
order:  
Lowest speaker output level/Highest speaker output  
level  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
Notes  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
• If “E-10:INTERNAL ERROR” appears during the testing  
procedure, restart from step 4.  
A-E/CAT.  
• If you selected “RELOAD” in step 4, no test tones are  
output.  
• If an error occurs during the “AUTO:CHECK” procedure,  
the setup procedure is canceled and an error screen  
appears. For details, see “If an error screen appears” on  
page 35.  
Notes  
• During the auto setup procedure, do not perform any  
operation on this unit.  
• When this unit detects potential problems during the  
“AUTO SETUP” procedure, “WARNING” and the  
number of warning messages appears in the above of  
“RESULT” (see page 36).  
• Depending on the listening environment, “SWFR  
PHASE:REV” appears during the “AUTO:CHECK”  
procedure and “SUBWOOFER PHASE” in “SOUND  
MENU” (see page 88) is automatically set to  
“REVERSE”.  
• We recommend getting out of the room while this unit is in  
the auto setup procedure. It takes approximately 3 minutes  
for this unit to complete the auto setup procedure.  
The display changes as follows.  
1 A TO:MENU  
ꢀSETUP;;;;;;;AUTO  
ꢀWIRING;;;;;CHECK  
ꢀꢀDISTANCE;;;CHECK  
ꢀꢀSIZE;;;;;;;CHECK  
ꢀꢀEQ;;;;;;;NATURAL  
ꢀꢀLEVEL;;;;;;CHECKꢀ  
. START  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p
[
2
AUTO:CHECK  
INITIALIZING  
.ꢀPRE CHECK  
MAIN CHECK  
EQUALIZING  
LEVEL  
CHECK CH=CENTER  
|||||;;;;;;;;  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]: Exit  
RESULT:EXIT  
. RESULTꢀꢀꢀ  
.
.
.
SP  
:
5/4/0.1  
DIST: 14.0/ 17.0ft  
LVL : -9.0/ +6.5dB  
SET CANCEL  
[
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
33 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO SETUP  
9
Press ENTER to display the setup results in  
detail.  
10 Press l/ hrepeatedly to toggle between the  
setup result displays.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
A-E/CAT.  
RESULT:EXIT  
Results of the speaker  
connection and wiring  
RESULT:WIRING  
FRONT L;;;;;;;OK  
. RESULTꢀꢀꢀ  
.
.
.
SP  
:
5/4/0.1  
DIST: 14.0/ 17.0ft  
LVL : -9.0/ +6.5dB  
SET CANCEL  
[
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Select  
p
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Return  
[
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
Results of the speaker  
distance from the  
listening position  
RESULT:DISTANCE1  
FRONT L;;14.0ft  
CENTER;;;17.0ft  
FRONT R;;15.0ft  
PRNS L;;;17.0ft  
PRNS R;;;17.0ft  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Select  
p
[
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Return  
RESULT:WIRING  
FRONT L;;;;;;;OK  
Results of the frequency  
response of each speaker  
RESULT:SIZE  
FRONT L;;;;;;LRG  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Select  
p
[
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Return  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Select  
ꢀꢀꢀ[pENTER]:Return  
[
Results of the parametric  
equalizer of each speaker  
RESULT:EQ  
CENTER 1:100Hz;;;+2.5dB  
2:300Hz;;;-0.5dB  
3:1.5kHz;;+0.5dB  
4:1.8kHz;;+2.5dB  
5:1.8kHz;;-3.5dB  
6:2.5kHz;;+2.5dB  
7:10kHz;;;+2.5dB  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Select  
p
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Return  
[
Results of the speaker  
output level  
RESULT:LEVEL1  
FRONT L;;;+1.0dB  
CENTER;;;;-1.5dB  
FRONT R;;;+6.5dB  
PRNS L;;;;-9.0dB  
PRNS R;;;;+1.0dB  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Select  
ꢀꢀꢀ[pENTER]:Return  
[
y
If you are not satisfied with the results or want to manually  
adjust each parameter, run “MANUAL SETUP” (see  
page 83).  
Notes  
• If you change speakers, speaker positions, or the layout of  
your listening environment, run “AUTO SETUP” again to  
recalibrate your system.  
• The distances displayed in the “DISTANCE” results may  
be longer than the actual distance depending on the  
characteristics of your subwoofer.  
• In the “EQ” results, different values may be set for the  
same band to provide finer adjustments.  
34 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO SETUP  
If an error screen appears  
11 Press ENTER to return to the top  
“RESULT:EXIT” display.  
Press k/ n/ l/ hto select “RETRY” or “EXIT”  
and then press ENTER.  
The following display is an example where “E-9:USER  
PRESET/CH  
RESULT:EXIT  
CANCEL” appears in the OSD.  
. RESULTꢀꢀꢀ  
.
.
.
SP  
:
5/4/0.1  
ENTER  
DIST: 14.0/ 17.0ft  
LVL : -9.0/ +6.5dB  
SET CANCEL  
RROR  
A-E/CAT.  
E-9:USER CANCEL  
[
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
. Don't operate  
any function.  
. ꢀRETRY EXIT  
[
ꢀꢀꢀ[p]/[[]:Select  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
12 Make sure the pointer is pointing at “SET”  
and “CANCEL” and then press l/ hto  
select “SET” or “CANCEL”.  
Choices: RETRY, EXIT  
Select “RETRY” to retry the “AUTO SETUP”  
procedure.  
PRESET/CH  
Select “EXIT” to exit from the “AUTO SETUP”  
procedure.  
RESULT:EXIT  
RESULTꢀꢀꢀ  
.
.
.
SP  
DIST: 14.0/ 17.0ft  
:
5/4/0.1  
ENTER  
LVL : -9.0/ +6.5dB  
A-E/CAT.  
. ꢀSET CANCEL  
[
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
Choices: SET, CANCEL  
• Select “SET” to confirm the “AUTO SETUP”  
results.  
• Select “CANCEL” to cancel the “AUTO SETUP”  
results.  
13 Press ENTER to confirm your selection.  
The top “SET MENU” display appears in the OSD.  
PRESET/CH  
ꢀꢀSET MENU  
.;AUTOꢀSETUP  
;MANUALꢀSETUP  
.;SIGNALꢀINFO  
ENTER  
ꢀꢀ[ ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
A-E/CAT.  
14 Press SET MENU to exit from “SET MENU”.  
SET MENU  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
Notes  
• After you have completed the “AUTO SETUP” procedure, be  
sure to disconnect the optimizer microphone.  
• The optimizer microphone is sensitive to heat. Keep it away  
from direct sunlight and do not place it on top of this unit.  
35 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO SETUP  
If “WARNING” appears  
When this unit detects potential problems during the  
“AUTO SETUP” procedure, “WARNING” appears in the  
“RESULT:EXIT” display. Check the warning messages to  
correct your speaker settings.  
Note  
Warnings differ from errors in that warnings do not cancel the  
“AUTO SETUP” procedure.  
1
Make sure the pointer is pointing at  
“WARNING” and then press ENTER to  
display the detailed information about the  
warning.  
The number on the right of “WARNING” indicates  
the number of warning messages.  
RESULT:EXIT  
. WARNING (3)  
RESULTꢀꢀꢀ  
.
.
.
SP  
:
5/4/0.1  
DIST: 14.0/ 17.0ft  
LVL : -9.0/ +6.5dB  
[SET CANCEL  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
2
Press l/ hrepeatedly to toggle between the  
warning displays.  
WARNING: W-1  
< OUT OF PHASE >  
Reverse Channel  
FL  
--  
CENTER  
PL  
SL  
PR  
SR  
SBL  
SBR  
p
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ] : Select  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER] : Enter  
[
y
• For details about each warning message, see the “AUTO  
SETUP” section in “TROUBLESHOOTING” on  
page 128.  
• When the corresponding warning message is not  
applicable to a speaker, “” is displayed instead.  
3
Press ENTER to return to the top  
“RESULT:EXIT” display.  
PRESET/CH  
RESULT:EXIT  
WARNING (3)  
RESULTꢀꢀꢀ  
SP  
DIST: 14.0/ 17.0ft  
LVL : -9.0/ +6.5dB  
.
.
.
:
5/4/0.1  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
. ꢀSET CANCEL  
[
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
36 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLAYBACK  
PLAYBACK  
CAUTION  
Extreme caution should be exercised when you play back CDs encoded in DTS. If you play back a CD  
encoded in DTS on a DTS-incompatible CD player, you will only hear some unwanted noise that may  
damage your speakers. Check whether your CD player supports CDs encoded in DTS. Also, check the  
sound output level of your CD player before you play back a CD encoded in DTS.  
y
To play DTS-encoded CDs when using a digital audio connection, set “DECODER MODE” in “INPUT MENU” to “DTS” before the  
playback (see page 95).  
Basic procedure  
2
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel  
(or set the operation mode selector to AMP  
and then press one of the input selector  
buttons on the remote control) to select the  
desired input source.  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
Front panel  
or  
5
2
4
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
XM  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
AMP  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
PHONO  
TUNER  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
SOURCE  
TV  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
2
XM MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
5
8
5
6
7
NIGHT ENHANCER  
SELECT  
9
0
+
10  
ENT  
Remote control  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
REC  
The name of the currently selected input source  
appears in the front panel display and in the OSD for  
a few seconds.  
2
4
DISC SKIP  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
Available input sources  
V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER XM  
1
Turn on the video monitor connected to this  
unit.  
INPUT: DVD  
y
Currently selected input  
source  
• See page 41 to display the input source information.  
You can display a gray background in the OSD when there  
is no video signal being input by setting “GRAY BACK”  
in “OPTION MENU” to “AUTO” (see page 96).  
You can change the display settings by using “SHORT  
MESSAGE” parameter in “DISPLAY SET”. See pages 97  
for details.  
Note  
For details about controlling XM Satellite Radio when  
“XM” is selected as the input source, see page 64.  
37 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLAYBACK  
Note  
3
Start playback on the selected source  
component or select a broadcast station.  
• Refer to the operating instructions for the source  
component.  
• See page 53 for details about tuning instructions.  
• See page 64 for details about XM Satellite Radio  
tuning instructions.  
Sound field programs and the Compressed Music Enhancer  
mode cannot be selected when the component connected to  
the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is selected as the input source  
(see page 40) and Audio input jack select is set to  
“ANALOG” (see page 39).  
y
• Choose a sound field program based on your listening  
preference, not merely on the name of the program.  
• When you select an input source, this unit automatically  
selects the last sound field program used with the  
corresponding input source.  
4
Rotate VOLUME on the front panel (or press  
VOLUME +/– on the remote control) to adjust  
the volume to the desired output level.  
• To display information about the currently selected input  
source in the OSD, see page 75 for details.  
VOLUME  
+
Guide to contents  
or  
VOLUME  
See  
When you want to...  
page  
Enjoy pure hi-fi stereo sound  
49  
49  
51  
Front panel  
Remote control  
Adjust the tonal quality of the front speakers  
Enjoy the compressed music sources in enhanced  
sound  
y
See page 50 to adjust the level of each speaker.  
Edit parameters of sound field programs  
75  
52  
Enjoy the sources which have wide dynamic range at  
night  
5
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front  
panel (or press one of the sound field  
program selector buttons on the remote  
control repeatedly) to select the desired  
sound field program.  
The name of the selected sound field program appears  
in the front panel display and in the OSD. See  
page 44 for details about sound field programs.  
Use headphones  
40  
50  
79  
42  
Enjoy multi-channel sources in 2-channel stereo  
Select a decoder to play back sources with  
Set this unit to the standby mode automatically  
PROGRAM  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
or  
STEREO  
5
Front panel  
Remote control  
Currently selected sound field program category  
MOVIE  
Sci-Fi  
Currently selected sound field program  
38 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLAYBACK  
AUTO  
HDMI  
Automatically selects input signals in  
the following order:  
(1) HDMI  
(2) Digital signals  
(3) Analog signals  
Selects only HDMI signals. When  
HDMI signals are not input, no sound  
is output.  
Selecting audio input jacks  
(AUDIO SELECT)  
This unit comes with a variety of input jacks. Use this  
feature (Audio input jack select) to switch the input jack  
assigned to an input source when more than one jacks are  
assigned to an input source.  
COAX/OPT Automatically selects input signals in  
the following order:  
y
• We recommend setting Audio input jack select to “AUTO” in  
most cases.  
You can adjust the default Audio input jack select of this unit by  
using “AUDIO SELECT” in “OPTION MENU” (see page 98).  
(1) Digital signals input at the  
COAXIAL jack.  
(2) Digital signals input at the  
OPTICAL jack.  
When no signals are input, no sound is  
output.  
Selects only analog signals. If no  
analog signals are input, no sound is  
output.  
1
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel  
(or press one of the input selector buttons on  
the remote control) to select the desired  
input source.  
ANALOG  
Note  
PHONO  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
INPUT  
This feature is not available when no digital input jack  
(OPTICAL, COAXIAL and HDMI) are assigned. In  
addition, HDMI is not available as an Audio input jack  
select setting when the HDMI IN 1 and HDMI IN 2 jacks  
are not used. Use “I/O ASSIGNMENT” in “INPUT  
MENU” to reassign the respective input jack (see page 93).  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
or  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
Front panel  
Remote control  
2
Press AUDIO SELECT on the front panel (or  
AUDIO SEL on the remote control) repeatedly  
to select the desired Audio input jack select  
setting.  
AUDIO SELECT  
AUDIO SEL  
or  
Available input sources  
V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER XM  
A.SEL: AUTO  
Currently selected  
Audio input jack  
select setting  
39 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLAYBACK  
Selecting the MULTI CH INPUT  
component  
Use this feature to select the component connected to the  
MULTI CH INPUT jacks (see page 25) as the input  
source.  
Using your headphones  
Connect a pair of headphones with a stereo  
analog audio cable plug to the PHONES jack on  
the front panel.  
Rotate the input selector on the front panel to  
select MULTI CH INPUT (or MULTI CH IN on the  
remote control).  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
MULTI CH IN  
or  
Front panel  
Remote control  
y
Use “MULTI CH SET” menu in “INPUT MENU” to set the  
parameters for MULTI CH INPUT (see page 95).  
y
Note  
When you select a sound field program, SILENT CINEMA mode  
activates automatically (see page 48).  
Sound field programs and the Compressed Music Enhancer mode  
cannot be selected when the component connected to the MULTI  
CH INPUT jacks is selected as the input source and Audio input  
jack select is set to “ANALOG” (see page 39).  
Notes  
• When you connect headphones, no signals are output at the  
speaker terminals.  
• When the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT  
jacks of this unit is selected as the input source and Audio input  
jack is set to “ANALOG” (see page 39), only the signals input  
at FRONT jacks are output from the connected headphones.  
• All Dolby Digital and DTS audio signals are mixed down to the  
left and right headphone channels.  
Muting the audio output  
Press MUTE on the remote control to mute the  
audio output. Press MUTE again to resume the  
audio output.  
MUTE  
y
You can also rotate VOLUME on the front panel or press  
VOLUME +/– on the remote control to resume the audio  
output.  
You can adjust the muting level by using the “MUTE TYPE”  
parameter in “SOUND MENU” (see page 92).  
• The MUTE indicator flashes in the front panel display when the  
audio output is muted and disappears from the front panel  
display when the audio output is resumed.  
40 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLAYBACK  
Audio information  
Signal format FORMAT  
Displaying the input source  
information  
You can display the format, sampling frequency, channel,  
bit rate and flag data of the current input signal.  
Signal format. When this unit cannot detect a digital  
signal, it automatically switches to analog input.  
Note  
“---” appears when this unit cannot detect any signals.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU on the remote control.  
The top “SET MENU” display appears in the OSD.  
Sampling frequency SAMPLING  
The number of samples per second taken from a  
continuous signal to make a discrete signal.  
AMP  
ꢀꢀSET MENU  
.;AUTOꢀSETUP  
;MANUALꢀSETUP  
.;SIGNALꢀINFO  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
TV  
MENU  
Note  
SRCH MODE  
“---” appears when this unit cannot detect the sampling  
frequency.  
ꢀꢀ[ ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
Channel CHANNEL  
The number of source channels in the input signal  
(front/surround/LFE). For example, a multi-channel  
soundtrack with 3 front channels, 2 surround  
channels and LFE, is displayed as “3/2/0.1”.  
2
Press nrepeatedly to select “SIGNAL INFO”  
and then press ENTER.  
The audio information about the input source appears  
in the OSD.  
Note  
“---” appears when there is no source channel available.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
Bit rate BITRATE  
The number of bits passing a given point per second.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
Note  
A-E/CAT.  
A-E/CAT.  
“---” appears when this unit cannot detect the bit rate.  
Dialogue normalization level DIALOG  
The dialogue normalization level preset to the current  
input Dolby Digital and DTS signal.  
3
Press k/ nrepeatedly to navigate the cursor  
in the OSD and press l/ hto toggle  
between the audio and video information  
displays.  
Flag FLAG  
Flag data encoded in DTS, Dolby Digital, or PCM  
signals that cue this unit to automatically switch  
decoders.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
Video information  
HDMI Signal Type HDMI SIGNAL  
Type of the HDMI signals input or output at the  
HDMI IN/OUT jacks of this unit.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
A-E/CAT.  
HDMI Resolution HDMI RES.  
Resolution of the HDMI signals input or output at the  
HDMI IN/OUT jacks of this unit.  
Navigating the cursor  
Selecting the audio or  
video information  
Analog Resolution ANALOG RES.  
Resolution of the analog signals input or output at the  
video jacks of this unit.  
4
Press SET MENU on the remote control again  
to exit from “SET MENU”.  
HDMI Error HDMI ERROR  
Error message for HDMI sources or connected  
HDMI devices. See page 128 for details.  
SET MENU  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
41 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PLAYBACK  
Playing video sources in the  
background of an audio source  
You can combine a video image from a video source with  
sound from an audio source. For example, you can enjoy  
listening to classical music while viewing beautiful  
scenery from the video source on the video monitor.  
3
Press SLEEP on the remote control  
repeatedly to set the amount of time.  
Each time you press SLEEP, the front panel display  
changes as shown below.  
SLEEP  
Press the input selector buttons on the remote  
control to select a video source and then an  
audio source.  
SLEEP 120min.  
SLEEP 90min.  
SLEEP OFF SLEEP 30min. SLEEP 60min.  
XM  
The SLEEP indicator flashes while you are switching  
the amount of time for the sleep timer. Once the sleep  
timer is set, the SLEEP indicator lights up in the front  
panel display, and the display returns to the selected  
sound field program.  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
Audio sources  
Video sources  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAP
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
SLEEP 120min.  
SLEEP  
y
Set the “BGV” parameter in the “MULTI CH SET” menu to the  
desired setting to select the default background video input source  
of the MULTI CH INPUT sources (see page 95).  
Flashes  
Using the sleep timer  
STRAIGHT  
Analog  
Use this feature to automatically set the main zone to the  
standby mode after a certain amount of time. The sleep  
timer is useful when you are going to sleep while this unit  
is playing or recording a source. The sleep timer also  
automatically turns off any external components  
connected to the AC OUTLETS (see page 28).  
SLEEP  
Lights up  
Canceling the sleep timer  
Press SLEEP on the remote control repeatedly  
until “SLEEP OFF” appears in the front panel  
display.  
1
Press one of the input selector buttons on  
the remote control to select the desired input  
source.  
SLEEP  
XM  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
D-R  
DVD  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAP
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
2
Start playback on the selected source  
component or select a broadcast station.  
Refer to the operating instructions for the source  
component.  
SLEEP OFF  
Disappears  
The SLEEP indicator turns off, and “SLEEP OFF”  
disappears from the front panel display after a few  
seconds.  
See page 53 for details about tuning instructions.  
y
The sleep timer setting can also be canceled by pressing  
STANDBY on the remote control (or MAIN ZONE ON/OFF on  
the front panel) to set the main zone to the standby mode.  
42 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
This unit is equipped with a variety of precise digital decoders that allow you to enjoy multi-channel playback from  
almost any stereo or multi-channel sound source. This unit is also equipped with a YAMAHA digital sound field  
processing (DSP) chip containing several sound field programs which you can use to enhance your playback experience.  
y
• When you set the “DECODER MODE” parameter in “INPUT MENU” to “AUTO”, this unit selects the appropriate digital decoder  
according to the input signal.  
• The YAMAHA CINEMA DSP modes are compatible with all Dolby Digital, DTS, and Dolby Surround sources.  
• The YAMAHA HiFi DSP sound field programs recreate real-world acoustic environments made from precise measurements taken in  
actual concert halls, music venues, movie theaters, etc. Thus, you may notice variations in the strength of the reflections coming from  
the front, back, left and right.  
You can change sound field parameters. See page 75 for details.  
Selecting sound field programs  
Notes  
• When you select an input source, this unit automatically selects the last sound field program used with the corresponding input source.  
• Sound field programs cannot be selected when the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is selected as the input  
source (see page 40) and Audio input jack select is set to “ANALOG” (see page 39).  
• When you play back DSD sources with any sound field program, this unit converts the DSD signals to PCM signals and then applies  
the selected program and Audio input jack select is set to “ANALOG” (see page 39).  
• When you play back DTS 96/24 sources with any sound field program, this unit applies the selected program without activating the  
DTS 96/24 decoder.  
• Sampling frequencies higher than 48 kHz are sampled down to 48 kHz or lower and then sound field programs are applied.  
Front panel operations  
Remote control operations  
AMP  
AMP  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
SOURCE  
TV  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
ON  
OFF  
MENU  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
SRCH MODE  
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
ENTER  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
A-E/CAT.  
INPUT  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
XM MEMORY  
Sound field program  
selector buttons  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
8
5
6
7
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
PROGRAM selector  
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and then  
press one of the sound field program selector  
buttons on the remote control repeatedly.  
The name of the selected sound field program appears in  
the front panel display and in the OSD.  
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front panel.  
The name of the selected sound field program appears in  
the front panel display and in the OSD.  
43 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
Sound field program descriptions  
y
Select a sound field program based on your listening preference, not merely on the name of the program, etc.  
Created sound  
fields (see  
page 10)  
CINEMA DSP  
or  
HiFi DSP  
Name of the  
program  
Remote control  
button  
Category of the  
program  
MOVIE  
4
MOVIE  
Sci-Fi  
This program clearly reproduces dialog and sound effects in the latest sound form for science fiction films, thus creating a broad and expansive  
cinematic space amid silence. You can enjoy science fiction films in a virtual-space sound field that includes Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital and  
DTS-encoded software employing the most advanced techniques.  
DSP LEVEL  
P.INIT. DLY  
P.ROOM SIZE  
S.INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG. LIFT  
Program description  
Available sound field parameters (see page 76)  
For music audio sources  
y
For audio music sources, we also recommend using the Pure Direct mode (see page 49), the “STRAIGHT” mode (see page 48) or  
surround decode mode (see page 79).  
CLASSICAL  
CLASSICAL  
Hall in Munich  
HiFi DSP  
1
This is a large fan-shaped concert hall which has approximately 2500 seats. Almost the whole interior is made of wood. There is relatively  
little reflection from the walls, and sound spreads finely and beautifully.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
ROOM SIZE  
LIVENESS  
DIALG.LIFT  
CLASSICAL  
CLASSICAL  
Hall in Vienna  
HiFi DSP  
1
A classic shoe-box type concert hall with approximately 1700 seats. Pillars and ornate carvings create extremely complex reflections which  
produce a very full, rich sound.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
ROOM SIZE  
LIVENESS  
DIALG.LIFT  
CLASSICAL  
CLASSICAL  
Hall in Amsterdam  
HiFi DSP  
1
This is a large 2200 seat shoe-box type concert hall in Amsterdam. It has a circular stage with seats located behind the stage.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
ROOM SIZE  
LIVENESS  
DIALG.LIFT  
CLASSICAL  
Church in Freiburg  
CLASSICAL  
HiFi DSP  
1
This program creates the acoustic environment of a big church located in south Germany. The reverberation delay is very long while the early  
reflections are smaller than with other sound field programs.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
LIVENESS  
REV.TIME  
REV.DELAY  
REV. LEVEL  
DIALG.LIFT  
44 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
CLASSICAL  
CLASSICAL  
Chamber  
1
HiFi DSP  
This program creates a relatively wide space with a high ceiling like an audience hall in a palace. It offers pleasant reverberations that are  
suitable for courtly music and chamber music.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
LIVENESS  
REV.TIME  
REV.DELAY  
REV. LEVEL  
DIALG.LIFT  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
Village Vanguard  
HiFi DSP  
2
A traditional jazz club in New York, located on 7th Avenue. This room has a low ceiling, and the “stage” is located at the corner of the room.  
This program creates an intimate “close-to-the music” feel.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
ROOM SIZE  
LIVENESS  
DIALG.LIFT  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
Warehouse Loft  
HiFi DSP  
2
This program simulates a space enclosed by concrete. An energetic sound field is created with relatively clear reflections from the walls.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
ROOM SIZE  
LIVENESS  
REV.TIME  
REV.DELAY  
REV. LEVEL  
DIALG.LIFT  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
Cellar Club  
HiFi DSP  
2
This program simulates a live house with a low ceiling and homey atmosphere. A realistic, live sound field features powerful sound as if the  
listener is in a row in front of a small stage.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
ROOM SIZE  
LIVENESS  
DIALG.LIFT  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
The Roxy Theatre  
HiFi DSP  
2
The ideal program for lively, dynamic rock music. The data for this program was recorded at LA’s hottest rock club. The listener’s virtual seat  
is at the center-left of the hall.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
ROOM SIZE  
LIVENESS  
REV.TIME  
REV.DELAY  
REV. LEVEL  
DIALG.LIFT  
LIVE/CLUB  
LIVE/CLUB  
The Bottom Line  
2
HiFi DSP  
This is the sound field at stage front in The Bottom Line, a famous New York jazz club. The floor can seat 300 people to the left and right in a  
sound field offering real and vibrant sound.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
ROOM SIZE  
LIVENESS  
DIALG.LIFT  
For various sources  
Note  
The available sound field parameters and the created sound fields differ depending on the input sources and the settings of this unit.  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Sports  
3
This program allows the listeners to enjoy stereo sport broadcasts and studio variety programs with enriched live feeling. In sports broadcasts,  
the voices of the commentator and sportscaster are positioned clearly on the center while the atmosphere of the stadium expands in an  
optimum space to offer the listeners with a feeling of presence in the stadium.  
DSP LEVEL  
P. INIT. DLY  
P. ROOM SIZE  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG.LIFT  
45 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Action Game  
3
This sound field has been optimized for action games such as car racing and FPS games. It uses the reflection data that limits the effects range  
per channel in order to offer a powerful playing environment with a being-there feeling by enhancing various effects tones while maintaining  
a clear sense of directions.  
DSP LEVEL  
P. INIT. DLY  
P. ROOM SIZE  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG.LIFT  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT Roleplaying Game  
3
This sound field has been optimized for role-playing and adventure games. It combines the sound field effects for movies and the sound field  
design used with “Action Game” to represent the depth and 3D feeling of the field during play, while offering movie-like surround effects in  
the movie scenes in the game.  
DSP LEVEL  
P. INIT. DLY  
P. ROOM SIZE  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG.LIFT  
For visual sources of music  
Note  
The available sound field parameters and the created sound fields differ depending on the input sources and the settings of this unit.  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Music Video  
HiFi DSP  
3  
This sound field offers an image of a concert hall for live performance of pop, rock and jazz music. The listener can indulge oneself in a hot  
live space thanks to the presence sound field that emphasizes the vividness of vocals and solo play and the beat of rhythm instruments, and to  
the surround sound field that reproduces the space of a big live hall.  
DSP LEVEL  
P. INIT. DLY  
P. ROOM SIZE  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG.LIFT  
ENTERTAIN  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Recital/Opera  
3
This program controls the amount of reverberations at an optimum level and emphasizes the depth and clarity of human voices. “Opera”  
offers the reverberations of an orchestra box in front of the listener at the same time as providing the acoustic positioning and feeling of  
presence on the stage. The surround sound field is relatively moderate, but the data for concert hall effects are used to represent the inherent  
beauty of music. The listener will not be fatigued even after long hours of opera entertainment.  
DSP LEVEL  
P. INIT. DLY  
P. ROOM SIZE  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG.LIFT  
For movie sources  
y
You can select the desired decoder used with following sound field program (except “Mono Movie”). See page 81 for details.  
Note  
The available sound field parameters and the created sound fields differ depending on the input sources and the settings of this unit.  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Standard  
4
This program create a sound field emphasizing the surrounding feeling without disturbing the original acoustic positioning of multi-channel  
audio such as Dolby Digital and DTS. It has been designed with the concept of “an ideal movie theater”, in which the audience is surrounded  
by beautiful reverberations from the left, right and rear.  
DSP LEVEL  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
S.LIVENESS  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
SB LIVENESS  
DIALG.LIFT  
46 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Spectacle  
4
This program creates the extremely wide sound field of a 70-mm movie theater. It precisely reproduces the source sound in detail, making  
both the video and the sound field incredibly real. This is ideal for any kind of video source encoded with Dolby Surround, Dolby Digital or  
DTS (especially large-scale movie productions).  
DSP LEVEL  
P. INIT. DLY  
P. ROOM SIZE  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG.LIFT  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Sci-Fi  
4
This program clearly reproduces dialog and sound effects in the latest sound form for science fiction films, thus creating a broad and  
expansive cinematic space amid silence. You can enjoy science fiction films in a virtual-space sound field that includes Dolby Surround,  
Dolby Digital and DTS-encoded software employing the most advanced techniques.  
DSP LEVEL  
P. INIT. DLY  
P. ROOM SIZE  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG.LIFT  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Adventure  
4
This program is ideal for precisely reproducing the sound design of the newest 70-mm and multichannel soundtrack films. The sound field is  
made to be similar to that of the newest movie theaters, so the reverberations of the sound field itself are restrained as much as possible.  
DSP LEVEL  
P. INIT. DLY  
P. ROOM SIZE  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG.LIFT  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Drama  
4
This sound field features stable reverberations that match a wide range of movie genres from serious dramas to musicals and comedies. The  
reverberations are modest but offer an optimum 3D feeling, reproducing effects tones and background music softly but cubically around clear  
words and center positioning in a way that does not fatigue the listener even after long hours of viewing.  
DSP LEVEL  
P. INIT. DLY  
P. ROOM SIZE  
S. INIT. DLY  
S. ROOM SIZE  
SB INI. DLY  
SB ROOM SIZE  
DIALG.LIFT  
MOVIE  
MOVIE  
Mono Movie  
4
This program is provided for reproducing monaural video sources (such as old movies). The program produces the optimum reverberation to  
create sound depth using only the presence sound field.  
DSP LEVEL  
INIT. DLY  
ROOM SIZE  
LIVENESS  
REV.TIME  
REV.DELAY  
REV. LEVEL  
DIALG.LIFT  
Stereo playback  
STEREO  
STEREO  
2ch STEREO  
5
Use this program to mix down multi-channel sources to 2 channels. See page 50 for details.  
DIRECT  
STEREO  
STEREO  
7ch STEREO  
5
HiFi DSP  
Use this program to output sound from all speakers. When you play back multi-channel sources, this unit downmixes the source to 2  
channels, and then output the sound from all speakers. This program creates a larger sound field and is ideal for background music at parties,  
etc.  
CT LEVEL  
SL LEVEL  
SR LEVEL  
SB LEVEL  
PL LEVEL  
PR LEVEL  
47 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAMS  
Using sound field programs without  
surround speakers (Virtual CINEMA  
DSP)  
Virtual CINEMA DSP allows you to enjoy the CINEMA  
DSP programs without surround speakers. It creates  
virtual speakers to reproduce the natural sound field.  
When you set “SUR. L/R SP” to “NONE” (see page 87),  
Virtual CINEMA DSP activates automatically whenever  
you select a CINEMA DSP sound field program (see  
page 44).  
Enjoying unprocessed input  
sources  
When this unit is in the “STRAIGHT” mode, 2-channel  
stereo sources are output from only the front left and right  
speakers. Multi-channel sources are decoded straight into  
the appropriate channels without any additional effect  
processing.  
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel (or on the  
remote control) to select “STRAIGHT”.  
Note  
Virtual CINEMA DSP will not activate even when “SUR. L/R  
SP” is set to “NONE” (see page 87) in the following cases:  
– when the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT  
jacks is selected as the input source (see page 40).  
– when headphones are connected to the PHONES jack.  
– when the Pure Direct (see page 49) or “2ch Stereo” mode (see  
page 50) is selected, or when this unit is in the “STRAIGHT”  
mode (see page 48).  
STRAIGHT  
STRAIGHT  
or  
EFFECT  
EFFECT  
STRAIGHT  
Enjoying multi-channel sources and  
sound field programs with headphones  
(SILENT CINEMA)  
SILENT CINEMA allows you to enjoy multi-channel  
music or movie sound, including Dolby Digital and DTS  
sources, through ordinary headphones. SILENT CINEMA  
activates automatically whenever you connect headphones  
to the PHONES jack while listening to CINEMA DSP or  
HiFi DSP sound field programs (see page 44). When  
activated, the SILENT CINEMA indicator lights up in the  
front panel display.  
Format  
Description  
Standard processing for Dolby  
Digital sources.  
Dolby Digital  
Standard processing for DTS  
sources. When the input source is  
DTS-ES Discrete or DTS-ES  
Matrix format, the respective  
indicator appears in the front  
panel display.  
DTS  
Plays back DSD (Direct Stream  
Digital) sources.  
DSD  
PCM  
Notes  
• SILENT CINEMA does not activate when the component  
connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks is selected as the  
input source (see page 40).  
• SILENT CINEMA is not effective when the Pure Direct (see  
page 49) or “2ch Stereo” mode (see page 50) is selected, or  
when this unit is in the “STRAIGHT” mode (see page 48).  
Plays back PCM (Pulse Code  
Modulation) sources.  
Plays back multi-channel PCM  
(Pulse Code Modulation) sources.  
MPCM  
Plays back analog sources.  
Analog  
Deactivating the “STRAIGHT” mode  
Press STRAIGHT on the remote control so that  
“STRAIGHT” disappears from the front panel  
display.  
The sound effect is turned back on.  
STRAIGHT  
STRAIGHT  
or  
EFFECT  
EFFECT  
48 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
Enjoying pure hi-fi sound  
Adjusting the tonal quality  
Use the Pure Direct mode to enjoy the pure high fidelity  
sound of the selected source. When the Pure Direct mode  
is activated, this unit plays back the selected source with  
the least circuitry.  
Use this feature to adjust the balance of bass and treble for  
the front L/R, center, presence L/R speaker channels and  
the subwoofer channel.  
1
Press TONE CONTROL on the front panel  
repeatedly to select the high-frequency  
response (TREBLE) or the low-frequency  
response (BASS).  
Press PURE DIRECT on the front panel (or on the  
remote control) to turn on or off the Pure Direct  
mode.  
The PURE DIRECT button on the front panel lights up  
while this unit is in the Pure Direct mode. The front panel  
display automatically dims.  
TONE CONTROL  
PURE DIRECT  
PURE DIRECT  
or  
2
Rotate the PROGRAM selector to adjust the  
high-frequency response (TREBLE) or the  
low-frequency response (BASS).  
Front panel  
Remote control  
Notes  
PROGRAM  
• When you play back the multi-channel PCM sources (less than  
192 kHz), this unit downmixes the multi-channel signals  
according to the “SPEAKER SET” in “BASIC MENU” (see  
page 86).  
• When the component connected to the HDMI IN jacks is  
selected as the input source and Audio input jack select is set to  
“AUTO” or “HDMI”, this unit does not turn off the video  
circuitry in the Pure Direct mode.  
• When you set the audio input mode to “AUTO”, “HDMI” or  
“COAX/OPT” (see page 39) and play back the Dolby Digital,  
DTS or multi-channel PCM sources, this unit activates the  
corresponding decoder.  
Bypassing the tone control circuitry  
Press TONE CONTROL repeatedly to select  
BYPASS and cancel the tone control.  
TONE CONTROL  
• The following operations are not possible when this unit is in  
the Pure Direct mode:  
– switching the sound field program  
– displaying the OSD  
– adjusting the “SET MENU” parameters (except for speaker  
level settings)  
Notes  
• If you increase or decrease the high-frequency or the low-  
frequency sound to an extreme level, the tonal quality of the  
surround speakers may not match that of the front L/R, center,  
presence L/R speakers and the subwoofer.  
– operating video functions (video conversion, etc.)  
• The Pure Direct mode is automatically canceled whenever this  
unit is turned off.  
• TONE CONTROL is not effective when PURE DIRECT is  
selected, or when MULTI CH INPUT is selected as the input  
source.  
y
The front panel display turns on momentarily when an operation  
is performed.  
49 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
Adjusting the speaker level  
You can adjust the output level of each speaker while  
listening to a music source. This is also possible when  
playing sources input at the MULTI CH INPUT jacks.  
Enjoying multi-channel sources in  
2-channel stereo  
You can mix down multi-channel sources to 2 channels  
and enjoy playback in 2-channel stereo.  
Note  
1
Set the operation mode to AMP and then  
press STEREO on the remote control  
repeatedly to select “2ch Stereo”.  
This operation will override the level adjustments made in  
“AUTO SETUP” (see page 31) and “SP LEVEL” (see page 89).  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press LEVEL on the remote control  
repeatedly to select the speaker you want to  
adjust.  
AMP  
STEREO  
SOURCE  
5
TV  
AMP  
LEVEL  
SOURCE  
TITLE  
TV  
2ch Stereo  
y
Display  
FRONT L  
CENTER  
FRONT R  
SUR. R  
SB R  
Adjusted speaker  
Front left speaker  
You can use a subwoofer with this program when “LFE/BASS  
OUT” is set to “SWFR” or “BOTH” (see page 86).  
You can also select the “2ch Stereo” mode by rotating the  
PROGRAM selector on the front panel.  
Center speaker  
Front right speaker  
Surround right speaker  
Surround back right speaker  
Surround back left speaker  
Surround left speaker  
Subwoofer  
2
Press PARAMETER and then l/ hto set the  
“DIRECT” parameter.  
PRESET/CH  
SB L  
PARAMETER  
DISPLAY  
SUR. L  
SWFR  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
Presence left speaker  
Presence right speaker  
PRNS L  
PRNS R  
Choices: AUTO, OFF  
• Select “AUTO” to bypass the decoders, DSP  
processors and the tone control circuitry only when  
“BASS” and “TREBLE” are set to 0 dB (see  
page 49).  
• Select “OFF” not to bypass the decoders, DSP  
processors and the tone control circuitry when  
“BASS” and “TREBLE” are set to 0 dB.  
y
• Once you press LEVEL on the remote control, you can  
also select the speaker by pressing k/ n.  
• Instead of “SB R” and “SB L”, “SB” is displayed if  
“SB L/R SP” is set to either “SMLx1” or “LRGx1” (see  
page 88).  
y
2
Press l/ hon the remote control to adjust  
the speaker output level.  
• When multi-channel signals (Dolby Digital and DTS) are  
input, they are downmixed to 2 channels and output from  
the front left and right speakers.  
• Press ito increase the value.  
• Press jto decrease the value.  
Control range: –10 dB to +10 dB  
• The low-frequency signals input from the front left and  
right speakers are redirected to the subwoofer in the  
following cases:  
PRESET/CH  
–“LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “BOTH” (see page 86).  
–“FRONT SP” is set to “SMALL” (see page 87) and  
“LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “SWFR” (see page 86).  
• Press PARAMETER again to exit from the parameter  
setting mode.  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
50 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
Choices: 2ch Enhancer, 7ch Enhancer, Off  
Selecting the Compressed Music  
Enhancer mode  
• Select “2ch Enhancer” to play back compression  
artifacts in 2-channel stereo.  
• Select “7ch Enhancer” to play back compression  
artifacts in 7-channel stereo.  
• Select “Off” to turn off the Compressed Music  
Enhancer mode.  
Compression artifacts (such as the MP3 format) are  
created by a lossy compression scheme where the audio is  
resampled to lower the bit rate and to remove sounds that  
are indistinguishable to typical human hearing. The  
Compressed Music Enhancer feature of this unit enhances  
your listening experience by regenerating the missing  
harmonics in a compression artifact. As a result, flattened  
complexity due to the loss of high-frequency fidelity as  
well as lack of bass due to the loss of low-frequency bass  
is compensated, providing improved performance of the  
overall sound system.  
Note  
When you select “Off”, this unit returns to the previously  
selected sound field program.  
Changing the parameter of the  
Compressed Music Enhancer mode  
Press PARAMETER and then l/ hon the  
remote control to select the desired effect level.  
The following display is shown in the OSD.  
Notes  
• When you play back DSD sources or PCM sources whose  
sampling frequencies are higher than 48 kHz, this unit samples  
them down to 48 kHz or lower and applies the Compressed  
Music Enhancer mode.  
PRESET/CH  
• The Compressed Music Enhancer mode is not effective with  
any of the sound field programs.  
PARAMETER  
ENTER  
DISPLAY  
A-E/CAT.  
Press ENHANCER on the front panel (or set the  
operation mode selector to AMP and then press  
ENHANCER on the remote control) repeatedly to  
select the desired Compressed Music Enhancer  
mode.  
The following display is shown in the OSD and the  
ENHANCER indicator lights up in the front panel display.  
MUSIC ENHANCER  
ꢀ2ch Stereo  
.ꢀ ꢀLOW  
[HIGH  
AMP  
ENHANCER  
ENHANCER  
SOURCE  
or  
ENT  
TV  
Choices: HIGH, LOW  
• Select “HIGH” for a high effect level.  
• Select “LOW” for a low effect level.  
y
Press PARAMETER to turn off the Compressed Music  
Enhancer mode parameter display.  
ENHANCER  
Note  
Set the effect level to “HIGH” or “LOW” according to the  
characteristics of a source. The high-frequency signals of  
some sources may be emphasized too much. In this case, set  
the effect level to “LOW”.  
Lights up  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀMUSICꢀENHANCER  
2chꢀEnhancerꢀꢀꢀꢀ  
51 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING AUDIO FEATURES  
y
“NIGHT:CINEMA” and “NIGHT:MUSIC” adjustments are  
stored independently.  
Selecting the night listening mode  
The night listening modes are designed to improve  
listenability at lower volumes or at night. Choose either  
“NIGHT:CINEMA” or “NIGHT:MUSIC” depending on  
the type of material you are playing.  
Notes  
You cannot use the night listening modes in the following  
cases:  
–when the Pure Direct mode (see page 49) is selected.  
–when the component connected to the MULTI CH  
INPUT jacks is selected as the input source (see  
page 40).  
–when headphones are connected to the PHONES jack.  
• The night listening modes may vary in effectiveness  
depending on the input source and surround sound settings  
you use.  
1
Press NIGHT on the front panel (or set the  
operation mode selector to AMP and then  
press NIGHT on the remote control)  
repeatedly to select “NIGHT:CINEMA” or  
“NIGHT:MUSIC”.  
AMP  
NIGHT  
NIGHT  
SOURCE  
TV  
or  
+
10  
Choices: NIGHT:CINEMA, NIGHT:MUSIC, OFF  
• Select “NIGHT:CINEMA” when watching films to  
reduce the dynamic range of film soundtracks and  
make dialog easier to hear at lower volumes.  
• Select “NIGHT:MUSIC” when listening to music  
sources to preserve ease-of-listening for all sounds.  
• Select “OFF” if you do not want to use this feature.  
y
When a night listening mode is selected, the NIGHT  
indicator lights up in the front panel display.  
2
Press l/ hon the remote control to adjust  
the effect level while “NIGHT:CINEMA” or  
“NIGHT:MUSIC” is displayed in the front  
panel display.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
Remote control  
Effect.Lvl:MID  
Choices: MIN, MID, MAX  
• Select “MIN” for minimum compression.  
• Select “MID” for standard compression.  
• Select “MAX” for maximum compression.  
52 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FM/AM TUNING  
FM/AM TUNING  
There are 2 tuning methods: automatic and manual. Automatic tuning is effective when station signals are strong and  
there is no interference. If the signal from the station you want to select is weak, tune into it manually. You can also use  
the automatic and manual preset tuning features to store up to 40 stations (A1 to E8: 8 preset station numbers in each of  
the 5 preset station groups). Furthermore, you can recall any preset stations and exchange the assignment of two preset  
stations with each other.  
Note  
Orient the connected FM and AM antennas for the best reception.  
FM/AM controls and functions  
Front panel functions  
Remote control functions  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
-
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
1
2
3
4
5
6
V
1
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
PRESET/TUNING  
SEARCH MODE  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
CATEGOR  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
DISPLA  
Y
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
SELECT  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE 2 VOLUME  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
INPUT  
Set to  
SOURCE  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
MENU  
2
3
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
7
A-E/CAT.  
5
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1 PRESET/TUNING, EDIT  
2
3
1
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
4
8
5
6
7
Switches the function of PRESET/TUNING/CH  
l
/
h
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
between selecting preset station numbers and selecting  
the tuning frequency.  
Edits the assignments of preset stations (see page 57).  
1 TUNER  
Selects “TUNER” as the input source. This unit is turned  
into the last selected station.  
2 FM/AM  
Switches the reception band between FM and AM (see  
page 54).  
2 BAND  
Switches the reception band between FM and AM (see  
page 54). This unit is turned into the last selected AM or  
FM station.  
3 A/B/C/D/E  
Selects one of the 5 preset station groups (A to E) (see  
page 56).  
3 PRESET/CH k/ n  
4 PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ h  
Selects one of the 8 preset station numbers (1 to 8) when  
the colon (:) is displayed in the front panel display (see  
page 57).  
Selects one of the 8 preset station numbers (1 to 8)  
when the colon (:) is displayed in the front panel  
display (see page 56).  
4 Numeric buttons  
Use numbers 1 through 8 to select preset stations (see  
page 58).  
Selects the tuning frequency when the colon (:) is not  
displayed in the front panel display (see page 55).  
5 MEMORY  
5 A-E/CAT. l/ h, A/B/C/D/E  
Selects one of the preset station groups (A to E) (see  
page 56).  
Stores a preset station in the memory. Hold down this  
button for more than 3 seconds to start automatic preset  
tuning (see page 56).  
6 TUNING MODE  
Switches between automatic tuning (the AUTO indicator  
is turned on) and manual tuning (the AUTO indicator is  
turned off) (see page 54).  
7 INPUT selector  
Selects “TUNER” as the input source.  
53 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FM/AM TUNING  
Automatic tuning  
Automatic tuning is effective when station signals are  
strong and there is no interference.  
3
Press TUNING MODE so that the AUTO  
indicator lights up in the front panel display.  
TUNINIG MODE  
DISPLAY  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
AUTO  
INPUT  
A FMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
No colon (:)  
Lights up  
3 2  
4 1 3  
If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning  
is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING to turn the  
colon (:) off.  
1
2
Rotate the INPUT selector to select “TUNER”  
as the input source.  
PRESET/TUNING  
INPUT  
SEARCH MODE  
EDIT  
Front panel  
4
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ honce to  
begin automatic tuning.  
When this unit is tuned into a station, the TUNED  
indicator lights up and the frequency of the received  
station is shown in the front panel display.  
• Press hto tune into a higher frequency.  
• Press lto tune into a lower frequency.  
Press FM/AM to select the reception band.  
“FM” or “AM” appears in the front panel display.  
FM/AM  
or  
FM  
AM  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
TUNED  
AꢀꢀFMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
Lights up  
54 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FM/AM TUNING  
Manual tuning  
If the signal received from the station you want to select is  
weak, tune into it manually.  
3
Press TUNING MODE so that the AUTO  
indicator disappears from the front panel  
display.  
TUNINIG MODE  
DISPLAY  
Note  
Manually tuning into an FM station automatically switches the  
tuner to monaural reception to increase the signal quality.  
VOLUME  
A FMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
No colon (:)  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
If a colon (:) appears in the front panel display, tuning  
is not possible. Press PRESET/TUNING (EDIT) to  
turn the colon (:) off.  
3 2  
4 1 3  
PRESET/TUNING  
SEARCH MODE  
EDIT  
1
2
Rotate the INPUT selector to select “TUNER”  
as the input source.  
4
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hto tune  
into the desired station manually.  
Hold down the button to continue searching.  
INPUT  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
Front panel  
Press FM/AM to select the reception band.  
“FM” or “AM” appears in the front panel display.  
FM/AM  
or  
FM  
AM  
55 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FM/AM TUNING  
Automatic preset tuning  
3
Press and hold MEMORY for more than 3  
seconds.  
The preset station number as well as the MEMORY  
and AUTO indicators flashes. After approximately 5  
seconds, automatic presetting starts from the current  
frequency and proceeds toward higher frequencies.  
You can use the automatic preset tuning feature to store up  
to 40 FM stations with strong signals (A1 to E8: 8 preset  
station numbers in each of the 5 preset station groups) in  
order. You can then recall any preset station easily by  
selecting the preset station number.  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
AUTO MEMORY  
A1:FMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
Flashes  
Flashes  
2
1 3  
When automatic preset tuning is completed, the front  
panel display shows the frequency of the last preset  
station.  
1
2
Rotate the INPUT selector to select “TUNER”  
as the input source.  
y
You can specify the preset number from which this unit  
stores FM stations. Press A/B/C/D/E and then PRESET/  
TUNING/CH l/ hrepeatedly after you perform step 3  
to select the preset station number under which the first  
station will be stored.  
You can begin tuning toward lower frequencies to store  
FM stations automatically. Press PRESET/TUNING so  
that the colon (:) disappears from the front panel display  
and then press PRESET/TUNING/CH lafter pressing  
and holding MEMORY for more than 3 seconds.  
INPUT  
Front panel  
Press FM/AM to select “FM” as the reception  
band.  
Notes  
“FM” appears in the front panel display.  
• Any stored station data existing under a preset station  
number is cleared when you store a new station under the  
same preset station number.  
• If the number of received stations does not reach 40 (E8),  
automatic preset tuning automatically stops after  
searching for all the available stations.  
FM/AM  
FM  
• Only FM stations with sufficient signal strength are stored  
automatically by automatic preset tuning. If the station  
you want to store is weak in signal strength, tune into it  
manually and store it as described in “Manual preset  
tuning” on page 57.  
56 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FM/AM TUNING  
Manual preset tuning  
You can also store up to 40 stations (A1 to E8: 8 preset  
station numbers in each of the 5 preset station groups)  
manually.  
4
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hto select a  
preset station number (1 to 8) while the  
MEMORY indicator is flashing.  
• Press hto select a higher preset station number.  
• Press lto select a lower preset station number.  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
MEMORY  
A1:FMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
3 4 2,5  
Preset station number  
Flashes  
1
2
Tune into a station automatically or manually.  
See pages 54 and 55 for tuning instructions.  
5
Press MEMORY while the MEMORY indicator  
is flashing.  
The station band and frequency appear in the front  
panel display with the preset station group and  
number you have selected. The MEMORY indicator  
disappears from the front panel display.  
Press MEMORY.  
The MEMORY indicator flashes in the front panel  
display for approximately 5 seconds.  
MEMORY  
MEMORY  
MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
Flashes  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
3
Press A/B/C/D/E repeatedly to select a preset  
station group (A to E) while the MEMORY  
indicator is flashing.  
The selected preset station group letter appears.  
Check that the colon (:) appears in the front panel  
display.  
A1:FMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
The displayed station has been stored as A1.  
A/B/C/D/E  
CATEGORY  
Notes  
• Any stored station data existing under a preset station  
number is cleared when you store a new station under the  
same preset station number.  
• The reception mode (stereo or monaural) is stored along  
with the station frequency.  
MEMORY  
A :FMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
Preset station Colon (:)  
group  
Flashes  
57 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FM/AM TUNING  
Selecting preset stations  
You can tune into any desired station simply by selecting  
the preset station group and number under which it was  
stored.  
2
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) to select the desired preset  
station number (1 to 8).  
The preset station group and number appear in the  
front panel display along with the station band and  
frequency.  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
PRESET/CH  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
or  
ENTER  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
A-E/CAT.  
Remote control  
Front panel  
1
2
AMP  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
SOURCE  
TV  
1
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
A1:FMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
ENTER  
1,2  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
y
When performing this operation with the remote control, set the  
operation mode selector to SOURCE and then press TUNER to  
select “TUNER” as the input source.  
1
Press A/B/C/D/E on the front panel (or set the  
operation mode selector to SOURCE and  
then press A-E/CAT. l/ hon the remote  
control) to select the desired preset station  
group (A to E).  
The preset station group letter appears in the front  
panel display and changes each time you press the  
button.  
A/B/C/D/E  
CATEGORY  
Front panel  
or  
PRESET/CH  
AMP  
SOURCE  
ENTER  
TV  
A-E/CAT.  
Remote control  
58 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FM/AM TUNING  
Exchanging preset stations  
You can exchange the assignments of two preset stations  
with each other. The example below describes the  
procedure to exchange preset station “E1” with “A5”.  
3
Select preset station “A5” using A/B/C/D/E  
and PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ h.  
“A5” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front  
panel display.  
See “Selecting preset stations” on page 58.  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
CATEGORY  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
MEMORY  
A5:FMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
4
3 3  
Flashes  
Flashes  
1
2
Select preset station “E1” using A/B/C/D/E  
and PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ h.  
See “Selecting preset stations” on page 58.  
4
Press EDIT again.  
“EDIT E1–A5” appears in the front panel display and  
the assignments of the two preset stations are  
exchanged.  
Press and hold EDIT for more than 3  
seconds.  
“E1” and the MEMORY indicator flash in the front  
panel display.  
PRESET/TUNING  
SEARCH MODE  
EDIT  
PRESET/TUNING  
SEARCH MODE  
EDIT  
EDIT E1-A5  
MEMORY  
E1:FMꢀ88.9ꢀMHz  
Flashes  
Flashes  
59 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
XM Satellite Radio is a satellite radio service with millions of listeners across the United States and Canada,  
broadcasting live daily. The XM Satellite Radio channel lineup includes over 160 digital channels of choice from coast to  
coast: 67 commercial-free music channels, featuring hip hop to opera, classical to country, bluegrass to blues; 33  
channels of premier sports, talk, comedy, children’s and entertainment programming; and more than 20 channels of the  
traffic and weather information for major metropolitan areas nationwide.  
Because XM Satellite Radio is a subscription service, you will need to set up an account and activate service with XM  
using your XM Satellite Radio ID number. To check your ID number, follow “Activating XM Satellite Radio” on  
page 62. For further information on XM Satellite Radio services, visit the XM Satellite Radio website at “http://  
www.xmradio.com/” (for residents in the United States) or “http://www.xmradio.ca/” (for residents in Canada).  
This unit is equipped with the Neural Surround decoder that plays back the surround sound content of the XM Satellite  
Radio broadcasts in multi-channels, resulting in a full surround sound experience.  
Notes  
Connecting the XM Passport System  
• The XM Satellite Radio service is only available in the 48  
Connect XM Passport and XM Passport Home Dock (sold  
contiguous United States (not available in Alaska and Hawaii)  
separately) to the XM jack on the rear panel of this unit.  
and Canada.  
For details, see the operating instructions provided with  
XM Passport System.  
• XM Passport System and monthly subscription are sold  
separately. For details, visit the XM Satellite Radio website at  
“http://www.xmradio.com/” (for residents in the United States)  
XM  
or “http://www.xmradio.ca/” (for residents in Canada).  
• For information on obtaining the XM Passport System, visit the  
XM Satellite Radio website at “http://www.xmradio.com/” (for  
residents in the United States) or “http://www.xmradio.ca/” (for  
residents in Canada), or consult your local retailer that sells XM  
Ready products.  
• To ensure optimal reception of the XM Satellite Radio signals,  
the XM Passport System must be placed at or near a southerly  
facing window with no obstacles in the path to the sky. You can  
mount it indoors or outdoors.  
Information from XM Satellite Radio Inc.  
XM Passport and XM Passport Home Dock  
(sold separately)  
XM monthly service subscription sold separately. XM  
Passport and XM Passport Home Dock required to receive  
XM service (sold separately). Installation costs and other  
fees and taxes, including a one-time activation fee may  
apply. Subscription fee is consumer only. All fees and  
programming subject to change. Channels with frequent  
explicit language are indicated with an “XL”. Channel  
blocking is available for XM radio receivers by calling “1-  
800-XM-RADIO (1-800-967-2346)” (for residents in the  
United States) or “1-877-GET-XMSR (1-877-438-9677)”  
(for residents in Canada). Subscriptions subject to  
Customer Agreement available at “http://  
www.xmradio.com/” (for residents in the United States) or  
“http://www.xmradio.ca/” (for residents in Canada). XM  
service only available in the 48 continuous United States  
and Canada. “XM Ready” is a trademark of XM Satellite  
Radio Inc. © 2006 XM Satellite Radio Inc. All rights  
reserved.  
60 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
XM Satellite Radio controls and functions  
Note  
The following controls are available only when “XM” is selected as the input source. Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel (or  
set the operation mode selector to SOURCE and then press XM on the remote control) to select “XM” as the input source.  
Front panel functions  
Remote control functions  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
1
2
3
4
5
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
PHONO  
TUNER  
1
PRESET/TUNING  
SEARCH MODE  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
CATEGOR  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
Y
DISPLA  
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE 2 VOLUME  
INPUT  
SELECT  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
5
6
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
MENU  
6
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
2
3
A-E/CAT.  
7
8
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
1 SEARCH MODE  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
Changes the search mode between the All Channel  
Search, Category Search, and Preset Search modes (see  
page 65).  
1
2
3
4
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
8
5
6
7
NIGHT ENHANCER  
9
0
+
10  
ENT  
9
REC  
2 CATEGORY  
DISC SKIP  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
(All Channel Search mode)  
Changes the channel category while staying in the All  
Channel Search mode.  
(Category Search mode)  
Changes the channel category.  
(Preset Search mode)  
Changes the preset channel group (A to E).  
1 XM  
Selects “XM” as the input source.  
2 PRESET/CH k/ n  
(All Channel Search mode)  
Searches for a channel within all channels. Press and hold  
for quick search.  
(Category Search mode)  
Searches for a channel within the selected category. Press  
and hold for quick search.  
(Preset Search mode)  
3 PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ h  
(All Channel Search mode)  
Searches for a channel within all channels. Press and hold  
for quick search.  
(Category Search mode)  
Searches for a channel within the selected category. Press  
and hold for quick search.  
(Preset Search mode)  
Changes the preset channel number (1 to 8).  
Changes the preset channel number (1 to 8).  
3 XM MEMORY  
Stores a preset channel in the memory (see page 69).  
4 MEMORY (MAN’L/AUTO FM)  
Stores a preset channel in the memory (see page 69).  
4 Numeric buttons  
5 DISPLAY  
(All Channel Search or Category Search mode)  
Use 1 to 9 and 0 to enter a channel number directly.  
(Preset Search mode)  
Displays the XM Satellite Radio information such as  
channel number, channel name, category, artist name, or  
song title displayed in the front panel display or in the  
OSD (see page 70).  
Use 1 to 8 to enter a preset channel number directly.  
5 Operation mode selector  
Set to SOURCE when you operate the XM Satellite Radio  
tuning function.  
6 INPUT selector  
Selects “XM” as the input source.  
61 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
6 SRCH MODE  
Activating XM Satellite Radio  
Changes the search mode between the All Channel  
Search, Category Search, and Preset Search modes (see  
page 65).  
To sign up for an account with the XM Satellite Radio  
service, an XM Satellite Radio ID number is required.  
Follow the procedure below to check your ID number, and  
then visit the website or call toll-free with a major credit  
card handy for signing up.  
7 A-E/CAT. l/ h  
(All Channel Search mode)  
Changes the channel category.  
(Category Search mode)  
Changes the channel category.  
(Preset Search mode)  
For residents in the United States  
URL: http://activate.xmradio.com/  
Toll-free: 1-800-XM-RADIO (1-800-967-2346)  
Changes the preset channel group (A to E).  
For residents in Canada  
URL: https://activate.xmradio.ca/on-line-activation/  
activation.jsp  
8 DISPLAY  
Displays the XM Satellite Radio information such as  
channel number, channel name, category, artist name, or  
song title displayed in the front panel display or in the  
OSD (see page 70).  
Toll-free: 1-877-GET-XMSR (1-877-438-9677)  
9 ENT  
Confirms an entered channel number in the Direct  
Number Access mode (see page 68).  
62 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
2
Check the XM Satellite Radio reception level  
and adjust the orientation of XM Passport  
System for a better percentage of the  
reception level.  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
y
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
You can display the XM Satellite Radio reception level by  
using the “XM ANTENNA” parameter in “OPTION  
MENU” (see page 99).  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
3 1  
Notes  
• If “CHECK ANTENNA” appears in the front panel  
display, XM Passport System may not be connected to the  
XM jack on the rear panel of this unit properly. See  
“Connecting the XM Passport System” on page 60 and  
check the connection.  
• The “XM ANTENNA” parameter in “OPTION MENU”  
(see page 99) cannot be adjusted by using the remote  
control. Instead, you need to adjust the orientation of XM  
Passport System connected to the XM jack of this unit for  
a better percentage of the reception level.  
AMP  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
SOURCE  
TV  
VOLUME  
POWER  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
1
TV  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
1
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
PHONO  
TUNER  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
3
ENTER  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
1
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel  
(or set the operation mode selector to  
SOURCE and then press XM on the remote  
control) to select “XM” as the input source.  
The cursor on the left of the XM indicator lights up in  
the front panel display.  
3
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) to select channel “0”.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
or  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
INPUT  
Front panel  
Remote control  
Note  
Front panel  
You cannot select channel “0” if the All Channel Search  
mode (see page 65) is not selected.  
or  
AMP  
4
Check the XM Satellite Radio ID number  
displayed in the front panel display and write  
it down.  
XM  
SOURCE  
TV  
Remote control  
ID:_____________________________________  
Lights up  
V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER XM  
63 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Basic XM Satellite Radio  
operations  
1
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel  
(or set the operation mode selector to  
SOURCE and then press XM on the remote  
control) to select “XM” as the input source.  
The cursor on the left of the XM indicator lights up in  
the front panel display and the XM Satellite Radio  
information (such as channel number, channel name,  
category, artist name, or song title) for the currently  
selected channel appears in the front panel display.  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
INPUT  
INPUT selector  
Front panel  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
or  
XM button  
PHONO  
TUNER  
AMP  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
XM  
SOURCE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
TV  
SELECT  
Remote control  
Lights up  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
Set to  
SOURCE  
V-AUX DVR/VCR  
2
VCR  
1
CBL/SAT DTV DVD MD/TAPE CD-R CD PHONO MULTI CH TUNER XM  
[001] Preview  
y
When you select “XM” as the input source, this unit  
automatically recalls the previously selected channel.  
Note  
The XM Satellite Radio signals cannot be output at the  
AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks.  
2
Search for a channel by using one of the XM  
Satellite Radio search modes.  
• To select a channel from the all channel list, see  
“All Channel Search mode” on page 65.  
• To select a channel by category, see “Category  
Search mode” on page 66.  
• To select a channel from the preset channels, see  
“Preset Search mode” on page 67.  
• To select the desired channel directly by entering  
the channel number, see “Direct Number Access  
mode” on page 68.  
y
You can use the Neural Surround decoder to enjoy the  
surround sound content of XM Satellite Radio broadcasts  
in multi-channels (see page 79).  
You can set the XM Satellite Radio preset channels (see  
page 69).  
You can display the XM Satellite Radio information in the  
front panel display or in the OSD (see page 70).  
64 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
All Channel Search mode  
2
Press CATEGORY on the front panel (or A-E/  
CAT. l/ hon the remote control) repeatedly  
to change the channel category.  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
PRESET/CH  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
A/B/C/D/E  
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
CATEGORY  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
or  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
ENTER  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
A-E/CAT.  
Front panel  
Remote control  
1
2
3
3
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) repeatedly to search for a  
channel within all channels.  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
1
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
2,3  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
PRESET/CH  
(U.S.A. model)  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
1
Press SEARCH MODE on the front panel (or  
SRCH MODE on the remote control)  
ENTER  
or  
A-E/CAT.  
repeatedly to select “ALL CH SEARCH”.  
Front panel  
Remote control  
PRESET/TUNING  
SET MENU  
SEARCH MODE  
or  
MENU  
EDIT  
SRCH MODE  
y
You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and  
holding PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the front panel  
(or PRESET/CH k/ non the remote control).  
Front panel  
Remote control  
ALL CH SEARCH  
65 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Category Search mode  
2
Press CATEGORY on the front panel (or A-E/  
CAT. l/ hon the remote control) repeatedly  
to change the channel category.  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
PRESET/CH  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
A/B/C/D/E  
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
CATEGORY  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
or  
INPUT  
ENTER  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
A-E/CAT.  
Front panel  
Remote control  
1
2
3
3
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) repeatedly to search for a  
channel within the selected channel  
category.  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
1
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
2,3  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
(U.S.A. model)  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
1
Press SEARCH MODE on the front panel (or  
SRCH MODE on the remote control)  
repeatedly to select “CAT SEARCH”.  
ENTER  
or  
A-E/CAT.  
PRESET/TUNING  
Front panel  
SET MENU  
Remote control  
SEARCH MODE  
MENU  
or  
EDIT  
SRCH MODE  
y
Front panel  
Remote control  
You can search for a channel quickly by pressing and  
holding PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the front panel  
(or PRESET/CH k/ non the remote control).  
CAT SEARCH  
66 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Preset Search mode  
Prior to selecting a preset channel in the Preset Search  
mode, you must preset XM Satellite Radio channels. For  
details, see “Setting the XM Satellite Radio preset  
channels” on page 69.  
2
Press CATEGORY on the front panel (or A-E/  
CAT. l/ hon the remote control) repeatedly  
to change the preset channel group (A to E).  
PRESET/CH  
y
The initial factory setting of all preset channels (A1 to E8) is  
“[001] Preview”.  
A/B/C/D/E  
CATEGORY  
or  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
VOLUME  
Front panel  
Remote control  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
3
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) repeatedly to change the  
preset channel number (1 to 8).  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
PRESET/CH  
1
2
3
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
ENTER  
PRESET/CH  
or  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
1
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
A-E/CAT.  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
2,3  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
Front panel  
Remote control  
(U.S.A. model)  
y
You can also select the preset channel number directly by  
pressing the numeric buttons (1 to 8) on the remote control.  
1
Press SEARCH MODE on the front panel (or  
SRCH MODE on the remote control)  
repeatedly to select “PRESET SEARCH”.  
PRESET/TUNING  
SET MENU  
SEARCH MODE  
MENU  
or  
EDIT  
SRCH MODE  
Front panel  
Remote control  
PRESET SEARCH  
67 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Direct Number Access mode  
2
Press the numeric buttons on the remote  
control to enter the desired three-digit  
channel number.  
For example, to enter the number 123, press the  
numeric buttons as shown below.  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
1
2
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
ENTERTAIN  
CLASSICAL  
LIVE/CLUB  
8
5
6
7
3
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
1
2
9
0
+
The display changes as follows.  
1
Press SRCH MODE on the remote control  
repeatedly to select “ALL CH SEARCH” or  
“CAT SEARCH”.  
<XM> --1  
SET MENU  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
Remote control  
<XM> -12  
<XM>123  
ALL CH SEARCH  
or  
CAT SEARCH  
y
• To enter a one-digit or two-digit channel number, press the  
numeric buttons on the remote control and then press ENT  
to confirm the input number.  
• Instead of pressing ENT to tune into the channel  
immediately, you can wait a few seconds until this unit  
confirms the entered channel number.  
• If no button is pressed within a few seconds after you enter  
a one-digit or two-digit number, this unit automatically  
confirms the entered channel number.  
• Pressing a button other than the numeric buttons or ENT  
cancels the Direct Number Access mode procedure.  
68 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Setting the XM Satellite Radio  
preset channels  
You can use this feature to store up to 40 XM Satellite  
Radio channels (A1 to E8: 8 preset channel numbers in  
each of the 5 preset channel groups). You can then recall  
any preset channel easily by selecting the preset channel  
group and number as described in “Preset Search mode”  
on page 67.  
2
Press MEMORY on the front panel (or XM  
MEMORY on the remote control).  
The MEMORY indicator flashes in the front panel  
display for approximately 5 seconds.  
MEMORY  
RETURN  
or  
XM MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
Front panel  
Remote control  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
MEMORY  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
Flashes  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
Note  
You must proceed to and carry out steps 3 through 5 while  
the MEMORY indicator is flashing in the front panel  
display.  
3 4 2,5  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
3
Press CATEGORY on the front panel (or A-E/  
CAT. l/ hon the remote control) repeatedly  
to select a preset channel group (A to E)  
while the MEMORY indicator is flashing.  
The preset channel group letter appears in the front  
panel display.  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
3,4  
2,5  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
PRESET/CH  
1
Search for a channel you want to set as a  
preset channel by using one of the XM  
Satellite Radio search modes.  
See “Basic XM Satellite Radio operations” on  
page 64 for details.  
A/B/C/D/E  
CATEGORY  
or  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
Front panel  
Remote control  
[043] XMU  
Currently selected channel number  
MEMORY  
C [043] XMU  
Currently selected preset channel group  
Flashes  
69 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
Displaying the XM Satellite Radio  
information  
You can display the XM Satellite Radio information (such  
as channel number, channel name, category, artist name,  
or song title) for the currently selected channel in the front  
panel display or in the OSD.  
4
Press PRESET/TUNING/CH l/ hon the  
front panel (or PRESET/CH k/ non the  
remote control) repeatedly to select a preset  
channel number (1 to 8) while the MEMORY  
indicator is flashing.  
The preset channel number appears in the front panel  
display.  
PRESET/CH  
VOLUME  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
or  
ON/OFF  
ENTER  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
A-E/CAT.  
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
Front panel  
Remote control  
DISPLAY  
MEMORY  
C5 [043] XMU  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
A-E/CAT.  
DISPLAY  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
Flashes  
XM MEMORY  
Currently selected preset channel number  
5
Press MEMORY on the front panel (or XM  
MEMORY on the remote control) to set the  
selected XM Satellite Radio channel as a  
preset channel while the MEMORY indicator  
is flashing.  
A colon (:) appears next to the preset channel number  
for confirmation, and the MEMORY indicator turns  
off in the front panel display.  
Note  
If a status message or an error message appears in the front panel  
display or in the OSD, see the “XM Satellite Radio” section in  
“TROUBLESHOOTING” on page 122 for appropriate remedies.  
Displaying the XM Satellite Radio  
information in the front panel display  
Press DISPLAY on the front panel or on the  
remote control repeatedly to toggle between the  
following XM Satellite Radio information display  
modes.  
MEMORY  
RETURN  
or  
XM MEMORY  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
Front panel  
Remote control  
TUNINIG MODE  
DISPLAY  
Channel number / name  
Front panel  
Channel category  
or  
C5: [043] XMU  
PARAMETER  
DISPLAY  
Artist name / Song title  
Remote control  
Colon (:)  
Note  
Once you set a new preset channel, the one previously  
stored in the same preset channel group and number is  
cleared.  
70 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XM SATELLITE RADIO TUNING  
When the channel number / name is displayed:  
Displaying the XM Satellite Radio  
information in the OSD  
[043] XMU  
Press DISPLAY on the remote control.  
The following screen is displayed in the OSD.  
TUNINIG MODE  
PARAMETER  
When the channel category is displayed:  
<CAT>Rock  
DISPLAY  
or  
DISPLAY  
Front panel  
Remote control  
When the artist name / song title is displayed:  
XM INFORMATION  
XM  
CHAN :XMU  
:Rock  
NAME :Coldplay  
ALL CH SEARCH  
:043  
CAT  
TITLE :Speed of sound  
.( Coldplay / Spe )  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:CHANNEL  
ꢀꢀꢀ[p]/[[]:CATEGORY  
Coldplay / Spe  
y
y
• To turn off the OSD, press DISPLAY on the front panel (or on  
• The front panel display can indicate up to 14 alphanumeric  
characters at once. You can set whether to display the XM  
Satellite Radio information in the front panel display in a  
continuous manner or by 14 alphanumeric characters at once by  
using the “FL SCROLL” parameter in “OPTION MENU” (see  
page 97).  
• If the XM Satellite Radio information contains a character that  
cannot be recognized by this unit, the character will be  
displayed with a space.  
the remote control).  
You can select the amount of time the XM Satellite Radio  
information is displayed in the OSD by using the “ON  
SCREEN” parameter in “OPTION MENU” (see page 97).  
• To hold the XM Satellite Radio information screen, press  
ENTER on the remote control while it is being displayed in the  
OSD.  
• The XM Satellite Radio information screen on hold is released  
if you press ENTER on the remote control again or if you  
change the XM Satellite Radio channel.  
Note  
• This unit can save up to two XM Satellite Radio information  
screens for future reference. To view the previous two XM  
Satellite Radio information screens, press TITLE on the remote  
control repeatedly while the current XM Satellite Radio  
information screen is being hold.  
If you press DISPLAY while the XM Satellite Radio information  
display is scrolling from right to left in the front panel display, the  
XM Satellite Radio information display mode toggles as  
described above.  
71 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING IPOD  
USING iPod  
Once you have stationed your iPod in a YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold separately) connected  
to the DOCK terminal of this unit (see page 26), you can enjoy playback of your iPod using the supplied remote control.  
You can also use the Compressed Music Enhancer mode of this unit to improve the sound quality of the compression  
artifacts (such as the MP3 format) stored on your iPod (see page 51).  
Notes  
• Only iPod (Click and Wheel), iPod nano, and iPod mini are supported.  
• Some features may not be compatible depending on the model or the software version of your iPod.  
y
• For a complete list of the remote control functions used to control your iPod, see the “iPod” column in “Controlling other  
components” on page 101.  
• For a complete list of status messages that appear in the front panel display and in the OSD, see the “iPod” section in  
“TROUBLESHOOTING” on page 128.  
• Once your iPod is stationed in a YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold separately) connected to the DOCK  
terminal of this unit, this unit begins signal transmission with your iPod.  
• Once the connection between your iPod and this unit is complete, “iPod connected” appears in the front panel display and the DOCK  
indicator lights up in the front panel display.  
• Only the analog audio and video signals of your iPod are input at the DOCK terminal, and the analog audio signals can be output at the  
analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks for recording.  
Your iPod battery is automatically charged when your iPod is stationed in a YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as the YDS-10, sold  
separately) connected to the DOCK terminal of this unit as long as this unit is turned on. You can also select whether this unit charges  
the battery of the stationed iPod or not when this unit is in the standby mode by selecting the “STANDBY CHRG” parameter in  
“OPTION MENU” (on page 99).  
• While the stationed iPod is being charged in the standby mode of this unit, the battery charge indicator (see page 9) appears in the front  
panel display. Once the charge is complete (or after 4 hours from the start of the charge), the indicator disappears.  
Controlling iPod in the menu browse  
Controlling iPod  
mode  
You can perform the advanced operations of your iPod  
You can control your iPod when “V-AUX” is selected as  
using the supplied remote control with the aid of the OSD  
the input source. The operations of your iPod can be done  
of this unit. The name of the song being played appears in  
with the aid of the OSD of this unit (menu browse mode)  
the front panel display according to the “FL SCROLL”  
or without it (simple remote mode).  
parameter in “OPTION MENU” (see page 97). You can  
also browse the songs stored on your iPod in the OSD.  
Further, you can change or adjust settings for your iPod to  
suit your personal preferences.  
Controlling iPod in the simple remote  
mode  
You can perform the basic operations of your iPod (play,  
stop, skip, etc.) using the supplied remote control without  
the aid of the OSD of this unit.  
Notes  
• Operations cannot be done with the controls on your iPod.  
• The YAMAHA logo appears in the display window of your  
y
You can view the photos or video clips stored on your iPod.  
iPod.  
• Operations can be also done with the controls on your iPod.  
• There are some characters that cannot be displayed in the front  
panel display or in the OSD of this unit. Those characters are  
replaced with underscores “_”.  
• The “Settings” parameters can be changed or adjusted only in  
the OSD. Press ENTER on the remote control to toggle between  
the “Settings” parameter settings.  
You cannot browse the photos or video clips stored on your  
iPod in the OSD. Instead, you must use the controls on your  
iPod to select the desired photos or video clips.  
72 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING iPod  
Shuffle Shuffle  
1
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE  
and then press DISPLAY on the remote  
control.  
Use this feature to set this unit to play songs or albums in  
random order.  
Choices: Off, Songs, Albums  
Select “Off to deactivate this feature.  
Select “Songs” to set this unit to play songs in random  
order.  
The following display appears in the OSD.  
AMP  
PARAMETER  
SOURCE  
Select “Albums” to set this unit to play albums in  
random order.  
DISPLAY  
TV  
Note  
iPod  
Top  
When “Shuffle” is set to a setting other than “Off , “  
” appears  
in the top right corner while songs or albums are being shuffled.  
Playlists  
Artists  
Albums  
Songs  
Genres  
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
Repeat Repeat  
Use this feature to set this unit to repeat one song or a  
sequence of songs.  
Composers  
Settings  
Choices: Off, One, All  
Select “Off to deactivate this feature.  
Select “One” to set this unit to repeat one song.  
Select “All” to set this unit to repeat a sequence of  
songs.  
2
Press k/ n / l/ hon the remote control to  
navigate the iPod menu and then press  
ENTER to begin playback of the selected  
song.  
Note  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
When “Repeat” is set to a setting other than “Off , “ or “  
1
All  
appears in the top right corner while one song or a sequence of  
songs are being repeated.  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
A-E/CAT.  
Choices: Playlists (playlists), Artists (artists), Albums  
(albums), Songs (songs), Genres (genres),  
Composers (composers), Settings (settings)  
• Playlists > Songs  
• Artists > Albums > Songs  
• Albums > Songs  
• Songs  
• Genres > Artists > Albums > Songs  
• Composers > Albums > Songs  
• Settings > Shuffle, Repeat  
73 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RECORDING  
RECORDING  
Recording adjustments and other operations are performed from the recording components. Refer to the operating  
instructions for those components.  
CAUTION  
The DTS signal is a digital bitstream. Attempting to digitally record the DTS bitstream will result in  
noise being recorded. Therefore, if you want to use this unit to record sources encoded in DTS, the  
following considerations and adjustments need to be made. To play DTS-encoded DVDs and CDs  
(when using a digital audio connection) on your DTS-compatible player, follow its operating  
instructions to make a setting so that the analog signal will be output from the player.  
Notes  
• When this unit is set to the standby mode, you cannot record between other components connected to this unit.  
• The settings of TONE CONTROL (see page 49), VOLUME, the speaker level (see page 89) and the sound field programs (see  
page 44) do not affect recorded material.  
• The source connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks of this unit cannot be recorded.  
• The XM Satellite Radio signals cannot be output at the AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks.  
• Digital signals input at the DIGITAL INPUT jacks are not output at the analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks for recording. Likewise,  
analog signals input at the AUDIO IN jacks are not output at the DIGITAL OUTPUT jack. Therefore, if your source component is  
connected to provide only digital or analog signals, you can only record digital or analog signals.  
• A given input source is not output on the same OUT (REC) channel.  
• S-video and composite video signals pass independently through the video circuits of this unit. Therefore, when recording or dubbing  
video signals input from a video source component that provides only an S-video or a composite video signal, you can record only an  
S-video or a composite video signal on your VCR.  
• The analog audio signals input at the DOCK terminal can be output at the analog AUDIO OUT (REC) jacks for recording.  
• Check the copyright laws in your country to record from CDs, radio, etc. Recording of copyrighted material may infringe copyright  
laws.  
y
Do a test recording before you start an actual recording.  
If you play back a video source that uses scrambled or encoded signals to prevent it from being dubbed, the picture  
itself may be disturbed due to those signals.  
2
Rotate the INPUT selector on the front panel  
(or press one of the input selector buttons on  
the remote control) to select the source  
component you want to record from.  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
INPUT  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
CD-R  
DVD  
or  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
2
Front panel  
Remote control  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
STANDBY  
POWER  
AV  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
PHONO  
TUNER  
3
4
Start playback on the selected source  
component or select a broadcast station.  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
2
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
Start recording on the recording component.  
1
Turn on all the connected components.  
74 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Changing sound field parameter  
settings  
You can enjoy good quality sound with the initial factory  
settings. Although you do not have to change the initial  
factory settings, you can change some of the parameters to  
better suit the input source or your listening room.  
3
Press one of the sound field program  
selector buttons repeatedly to select the  
desired sound field program you want to  
adjust.  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
STEREO  
5
Note  
You cannot change the sound field parameter values when  
“MEMORY GUARD” in “OPTION MENU” is set to “ON” (see  
page 98). If you want to change the sound field parameter values,  
set “MEMORY GUARD” to “OFF”.  
4
Press k/ nto select the desired sound field  
parameter and then l/ hto change the  
selected sound field parameter value.  
• Press hto increase the value.  
AMP  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
SOURCE  
TV  
2
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
• Press lto decrease the value.  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
4
3
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
2,5  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
8
5
6
7
ENTER  
ENTER  
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
A-E/CAT.  
A-E/CAT.  
y
1
2
Turn on the video monitor connected to this  
unit.  
• For details about the function and control range of each sound  
field parameter, see page 76.  
• When you set a sound field parameter to a value other than the  
initial factory settings, an asterisk mark (*) appears by the  
sound field parameter name in the OSD.  
• Repeat steps 3 and 4 as necessary to change other sound field  
program parameter settings.  
• The available sound field parameters for some of the sound field  
programs may be displayed on more than one page in the OSD.  
In this case, press k/ nto scroll through pages.  
• If you press and hold l/ hto change the sound field  
parameter value, the initial factory settings are shown  
momentarily in the front panel display.  
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press PARAMETER on the remote  
control.  
The following display is shown in the OSD.  
AMP  
PARAMETER  
SOURCE  
TV  
DISPLAY  
• Use the “PARAM. INI” feature in “OPTION MENU” to  
initialize the parameters of each sound field program within a  
sound field program group (see page 98).  
Sound field program category  
• To initialize the parameters of the selected sound field program,  
press nrepeatedly to select “PARAM. INIT” and then press h  
repeatedly.  
MOVIE  
Sci-fi  
Cursor  
.ꢀ<ꢀPROꢀLOGICꢀ>  
DSPꢀLEVEL;;;+0dB  
P.INIT.DLY;;16ms  
P.ROOM SIZE;;1.0  
S.INIT.DLY;;16ms  
5
Press PARAMETER to turn off the sound field  
parameter display.  
PARAMETER  
DISPLAY  
Sound field parameters Sound field parameter  
values  
75 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Sound field parameter descriptions  
You can adjust the values of certain digital sound field parameters so that the sound fields are recreated accurately in your  
listening room. Not all of the following parameters are found in every program.  
y
To change sound field parameter settings to suit your listening environment, see page 75 for details.  
Sound field parameter  
Features  
DSP level. Adjusts the level of all the DSP effect sounds within a narrow range. Depending on  
the acoustics of your listening room, you may want to increase or decrease the DSP effect level  
relative to the level of the direct sound.  
DSP LEVEL  
Control range: –6 dB to +3 dB  
Initial delay. Presence, surround, and surround back initial delay. Changes the apparent distance  
from the source sound by adjusting the delay between the direct sound and the first reflection  
heard by the listener. The smaller the value, the closer the sound source seems to the listener. The  
larger the value, the farther it seems. For a small room, set to a small value. For a large room, set  
to a large value.  
INIT.DLY  
P.INIT.DLY  
S.INIT.DLY  
SB INI.DLY  
Control range: 1 to 99 ms (INIT.DLY and P.INIT.DLY)  
1 to 49 ms (S.INIT.DLY and SB INI.DLY)  
Source sound  
Early  
reflections  
Time  
Time  
Time  
Delay  
Delay  
Delay  
Sound source  
Reflection face  
Small value = 1 ms  
Large value = 99 ms  
76 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Sound field parameter  
Features  
Room size. Presence, surround, and surround back room size. Adjusts the apparent size of the  
surround sound field. The larger the value, the larger the surround sound field becomes. As the  
sound is repeatedly reflected around a room, the larger the hall is, the longer the time between  
the original reflected sound and the subsequent reflections. By controlling the time between the  
reflected sounds, you can change the apparent size of the virtual venue. Changing this parameter  
from one to two doubles the apparent length of the room.  
ROOM SIZE  
P.ROOM SIZE  
S.ROOM SIZE  
SB ROOM SIZE  
Control range: 0.1 to 2.0  
Source sound  
Early  
reflections  
Time  
Time  
Time  
Sound source  
Small value = 0.1  
Large value = 2.0  
Liveness. Surround and surround back liveness. Adjusts the reflectivity of the virtual walls in the  
hall by changing the rate at which the early reflections decay. The early reflections of a sound  
source decay much faster in a room with acoustically absorbent wall surfaces than in one which  
has highly reflective surfaces. A room with acoustically absorbent surfaces is referred to as  
“dead”, while a room with highly reflective surfaces is referred to as “live”. This parameter lets  
you adjust the early reflection decay rate and thus the “liveness” of the room.  
LIVENESS  
S.LIVENESS  
SB LIVENESS  
Control range: 0 to 10  
Source sound  
Live  
Dead  
Time  
Time  
Time  
Small reflected  
sound  
Large reflected  
sound  
Small value = 0  
Large value = 10  
77 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Sound field parameter  
Features  
Reverberation time. Adjusts the amount of time taken for the dense, subsequent reverberation  
sound to decay by 60 dB at 1 kHz. This changes the apparent size of the acoustic environment  
over an extremely wide range. Set a longer reverberation time for “dead” sources and listening  
room environments, and a shorter time for “live” sources and listening room environments.  
REV.TIME  
Control range: 1.0 to 5.0 s  
Reverberation  
Source sound  
Reverberation  
Early reflections  
60 dB  
60 dB  
60 dB  
REV.TIME  
REV.TIME  
REV.TIME  
Sound source  
Short  
reverberation  
Long  
reverberation  
Small value = 1.0 s  
Large value = 5.0 s  
Reverberation delay. Adjusts the time difference between the beginning of the direct sound and  
the beginning of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the later the reverberation sound  
begins. A later reverberation sound makes you feel as if you are in a larger acoustic environment.  
REV.DELAY  
Control range: 0 to 250 ms  
Source sound  
(dB)  
60 dB  
Reverberation  
Time  
REV.DELAY  
REV.TIME  
Reverberation level. Adjusts the volume of the reverberation sound. The larger the value, the  
stronger the reverberation becomes.  
REV.LEVEL  
Control range: 0 to 100%  
Source sound  
REV. LEVEL  
Time  
78 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Sound field parameter  
Features  
Dialog lift. Adjusts the height of the front and center channel sounds by assigning some of the  
front and center channel elements to the presence speakers. The larger the parameter, the higher  
the position of the front and center channel sound.  
DIALG.LIFT  
Choices: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5  
2-channel stereo direct. Bypasses the decoders and DSP processors of this unit for pure hi-fi  
stereo sound when playing 2-channel analog sources.  
2ch Stereo  
DIRECT  
Choices: AUTO, OFF  
y
• Select “AUTO” to bypass the decoders, DSP processors and the tone control circuitry only  
when “BASS” and “TREBLE” are set to 0 dB (see page 49).  
• Select “OFF” not to bypass the decoders, DSP processors and the tone control circuitry when  
“BASS” and “TREBLE” are set to 0 dB.  
• When multi-channel signals (Dolby Digital and DTS) are input, they are downmixed to 2  
channels and output from the front left and right speakers.  
• The low-frequency signals input from the front left and right speakers are redirected to the  
subwoofer in the following cases:  
– “LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “BOTH” (see page 86).  
– “FRONT SP” is set to “SMALL” (see page 87) and “LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “SWFR”  
(see page 86).  
7-channel stereo center, surround left, surround right, surround back, presence left and presence right  
levels. Adjusts the volume level of each channel in the 7-channel stereo mode.  
7ch Stereo  
CT LEVEL  
SL LEVEL  
SR LEVEL  
SB LEVEL  
PL LEVEL  
PR LEVEL  
Control range: 0 to 100%  
Selecting decoders  
2
Press SELECT on the remote control  
repeatedly to select the desired decoder.  
You can select from the following modes depending  
on the type of source you are playing and your  
personal preference.  
Selecting decoders for 2-channel  
sources (surround decode mode)  
Use this feature to play back sources with selected  
decoders. You can play back 2-channel sources on multi-  
channels.  
SELECT  
7
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SUR. DECODE on the remote  
control to select the surround decode mode.  
y
You can select the desired decoder by pressing SELECT  
and then press l/ hrepeatedly on the remote control.  
You can change the decoder parameter settings. Press  
PARAMETER and then k/ nrepeatedly on the remote  
control to select the desired decoder parameter. You can  
change the value of the selected parameter by pressing l/  
hrepeatedly on the remote control.  
AMP  
SUR. DECODE  
SOURCE  
6
TV  
79 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Decoder descriptions  
Name of the  
program  
Remote control  
button  
Category of the  
program  
SUR.DECODE  
PLꢀIIxꢀMusic  
PLꢀIIꢀMusic  
SURROUND DECODE  
6
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for music sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not  
available when “SB L/R SP” is set to “NONE” (see page 88).  
PANORAMA  
DIMENSION  
CENTER WIDTH  
Program description  
Available sound field parameters (see page 76)  
SUR.DECODE  
SURROUND DECODE  
PRO LOGIC  
6
Dolby Pro Logic processing for any sources.  
SUR.DECODE  
PLIIx Movie  
PL II Movie  
SURROUND DECODE  
6
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for movie sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “SB L/R SP”  
is set to “NONE” (see page 88).  
SUR.DECODE  
PLIIx Music  
PL II Music  
SURROUND DECODE  
6
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for music sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “SB L/R SP”  
is set to “NONE” (see page 88).  
PANORAMA  
DIMENSION  
CENTER WIDTH  
PLIIx Game  
PL II Game  
SUR.DECODE  
SURROUND DECODE  
6
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby Pro Logic II) processing for game sources. The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “SB L/R SP”  
is set to “NONE” (see page 88).  
SUR.DECODE  
SURROUND DECODE Neo: 6 Cinema  
6
DTS processing for movie sources.  
SUR.DECODE  
SURROUND DECODE  
Neo:6 Music  
6
DTS processing for music sources.  
C. IMAGE  
SUR.DECODE  
SURROUND DECODE  
neural sur.  
6
Neural Surround processing for any sources.  
The Neural Surround decoder is compatible with PCM signals (32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz, 64 kHz, 88.2 kHz and 96 kHz) and analog 2-  
channel input sources. When Neural Surround-incompatible signals are being input while the Neural Surround decoder is selected, multi-  
channel sources are decoded straight into the appropriate channels without any additional effect processing and the Neural Surround-  
incompatible PCM signals are played back in stereo. The Neural Surround decoder is especially suitable for the XM HD Surround program of  
XM Satellite Radio.  
y
When you select the surround decode mode for Dolby Digital, DTS or DTS 96/24 sources, this unit automatically selects “SURROUND  
DECODE Dolby Digital”, “SURROUND DECODE DTS” or “SURROUND DECODE DTS 96/24” program.  
80 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Decoder parameter descriptions  
Decoder parameter  
Features  
Pro Logic IIx Music and Pro Logic II Music panorama. Sends stereo signals to the surround speakers as  
well as the front speakers for a wraparound effect.  
PRO LOGIC IIx Music  
PRO LOGIC II Music  
PANORAMA  
Choices: OFF, ON  
Pro Logic IIx Music and Pro Logic II Music dimension. Adjusts the sound field either towards the front  
or towards the rear.  
PRO LOGIC IIx Music  
PRO LOGIC II Music  
DIMENSION  
Control range: –3 (towards the rear) to +3 (towards the front)  
Initial setting: STD (standard)  
Pro Logic IIx Music and Pro Logic II Music center width. Moves the center channel output completely  
towards the center speaker or towards the front left and right speakers. A larger value moves the center  
channel output towards the front left and right speakers.  
PRO LOGIC IIx Music  
PRO LOGIC II Music  
CENTER WIDTH  
Control range: 0 (center channel sound is output only from the center speaker) to  
7 (center channel sound is output only from the front left and right speakers)  
Initial setting: 3  
DTS Neo:6 Music center image. Adjusts the front left and right channel output relative to the center  
channel to make the center channel more or less dominant as necessary.  
DTS Neo:6 Music  
C.IMAGE  
Control range: 0.0 to 1.0  
Initial setting: 0.3  
Available decoders  
Selecting decoders used with sound  
field programs  
Decoder  
Functions  
Use this feature to select the desired decoder used with  
MOVIE sound field programs (except “Mono Movie”).  
See page 46 for details about MOVIE sound field  
program.  
Dolby Pro Logic processing for  
any sources  
PRO LOGIC  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx (or Dolby  
Pro Logic II) processing for  
movie sources. The Pro Logic IIx  
decoder is not available when “SB  
L/R SP” is set to “NONE” (see  
page 88).  
PLIIx Movie  
PLII Movie  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press MOVIE on the remote control  
repeatedly to select the desired MOVIE  
sound field programs.  
DTS processing for movie  
sources  
Neo:6 Cinema  
AMP  
MOVIE  
SOURCE  
4
TV  
2
Press SELECT repeatedly to select the  
desired decoder used with the selected  
sound field program.  
You can select from the following decoders  
depending on the type of source you are playing and  
your personal preference.  
y
You can select the desired decoder by pressing SELECT and  
then press l/ hrepeatedly on the remote control.  
81 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SOUND CONFIGURATIONS  
Decoders  
Selecting decoders for multi-channel  
sources  
If you connected surround back speakers, use this feature  
to enjoy 6.1/7.1-channel playback for multi-channel  
sources using the Dolby Pro Logic IIx, Dolby Digital EX  
or DTS-ES decoders.  
You can select from the following decoders depending on  
the format of the source you are playing.  
Decoder  
Functions  
Plays back multi-channel  
sources in 7.1 channels using  
the Pro Logic IIx movie  
decoder.  
PLIIxMovie  
q D+PLIIx Movie  
DTS+PLIIx Movie  
MPCM+PLIIx Movie  
DSD+PLIIx Movie  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press EXTD SUR. on the remote control  
repeatedly to switch between 5.1 and 6.1/7.1-  
channel playback.  
Plays back multi-channel  
sources in 6.1/7.1 channels  
using the Pro Logic IIx music  
decoder.  
PLIIxMusic  
AMP  
q D+PLIIx Music  
DTS+PLIIx Music  
MPCM+PLIIx Music  
DSD+PLIIx Music  
EXTD SUR.  
SOURCE  
8
TV  
Plays back DTS signals in 6.1/  
7.1 channels using the DTS-ES  
decoder.  
DTS ES  
DTS 96/24 ES  
2
Press l/ hrepeatedly to select a decoder  
while the name of the decoder is displayed.  
PRESET/CH  
Plays back multi-channel  
sources in 6.1/7.1 channels  
using the Dolby Digital EX  
decoder.  
DOLBY D EX  
DTS+DOLBY EX  
MPCM+DOLBY EX  
DSD+DOLBY EX  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
Off OFF  
Decoders are not used to create 6.1/7.1 channels.  
Auto AUTO  
Notes  
When a signal flag that can be recognized by this unit is  
input, this unit selects the optimum decoder to play back  
the signal in 6.1/7.1 channels.  
• “PLIIx Movie” is available only when “SB L/R SP” (see  
page 88) is set to “SMLx2” or “LRGx2”.  
If this unit cannot recognize the flag or no flag is present  
in the input signal, it cannot automatically be played in  
6.1/7.1 channels.  
• Some 6.1/7.1-channel compatible discs do not have a signal flag  
that can be automatically detected by this unit. When playing  
these kinds of discs in 6.1/7.1 channels, select a decoder  
manually from “PLIIx Music”, “EX/ES” or “EX”.  
• 6.1/7.1-channel playback is not possible even if you press  
EXTD SUR. in the following cases:  
– when “SUR. L/R SP” (see page 87) or “SB L/R SP” (see  
page 88) is set to “NONE”.  
– when the component connected to the MULTI CH INPUT  
jacks is being played.  
– when the source being played does not contain surround left  
and right channel signals.  
– when a Dolby Digital KARAOKE source is being played.  
– when the “2ch Stereo” (see page 50) or Pure Direct (see  
page 49) mode is selected.  
• When this unit is turned off, this setting will be reset to  
“AUTO”.  
• The Pro Logic IIx decoder is not available when “SB L/R SP” is  
set to “NONE” (see page 88).  
82 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
You can use the following parameters in “SET MENU” to adjust a variety of system settings and customize the way this  
unit operates. Change the initial settings (indicated in bold under each parameter) to reflect the needs of your listening  
environment.  
Auto setup AUTO SETUP  
Use this feature to automatically adjust speaker and system parameters (see page 31).  
Manual setup MANUAL SETUP  
Use this feature to manually adjust speaker and system parameters.  
Basic menu 1 BASIC MENU  
Use this menu to manually adjust basic system parameters.  
Parameter  
Features  
Page  
Selects the size of each speaker, the speakers for low-frequency signal output, and the  
crossover frequency.  
86  
A)SPEAKER SET  
Adjusts the output level of each speaker.  
Adjusts the delay time of each speaker.  
89  
89  
B)SP LEVEL  
C)SP DISTANCE  
Turns the test tone output on or off for the SPEAKER SET, SPEAKER LEVEL and SP  
DISTANCE setting.  
90  
D)TEST TONE  
Sound menu 2 SOUND MENU  
Use this menu to manually adjust any speaker settings, alter the quality and tone of the sound output by the system or  
compensate for video signal processing delays when using LCD monitors or projectors.  
Parameter  
A)EQUALIZER  
B)LFE LEVEL  
C)DYNAMIC RANGE  
D)AUDIO SET  
E)HDMI SET  
Features  
Adjusts the tonal quality of the center speaker.  
Page  
90  
Adjusts the output level of the LFE channel for Dolby Digital or DTS signals.  
Adjusts the dynamic range of Dolby Digital or DTS signals.  
Adjusts the muting level, audio delay and tone bypass settings.  
Selects the component to play back HDMI audio signals.  
91  
91  
92  
92  
83 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Input menu 3 INPUT MENU  
Use this menu to manually reassign the input/output jacks, select the input mode or rename the input source.  
Parameter  
Features  
Assigns the input/output jacks of this unit according to the component to be used.  
Changes the name of the input source.  
Page  
93  
A)I/O ASSIGNMENT  
B)INPUT RENAME  
C)VOLUME TRIM  
94  
Adjusts the output volume of each jack.  
95  
Selects the input mode for the sources connected to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks on the rear  
panel of this unit.  
95  
95  
D)DECODER MODE  
E)MULTI CH SET  
Adjusts the direction of the signals input into the center, subwoofer, and surround channels  
when a source component is connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks.  
Option menu 4 OPTION MENU  
Use this menu to manually adjust the optional system parameters.  
Parameter  
Features  
Page  
96  
Adjusts the brightness of the display and converts video signals.  
Locks sound field program parameters and other “SET MENU” settings.  
Initializes the parameters of a group of sound field programs.  
A)DISPLAY SET  
B)MEMORY GUARD  
C)AUDIO SELECT  
98  
98  
Selects whether to initialize the settings or to recall the previous settings for the input mode  
selected in INPUT MENU.  
D)DECODER MODE  
98  
Initializes the parameters of a group of sound field programs.  
Adjusts the Zone 2 parameters.  
98  
99  
99  
E)PARAM.INI  
F)ZONE SET  
Displays the current reception level of XM Passport System.  
G)XM RADIO SET  
Selects whether this unit charges the battery of the connected iPod or not when this unit is in  
the standby mode.  
99  
H)DOCK SET  
Signal information SIGNAL INFO  
Note  
Use this feature to check audio signal information (see page 41).  
84 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Using SET MENU  
Use the remote control to access and adjust each  
parameter.  
2
3
Press k/ nto select “MANUAL SETUP”.  
PRESET/CH  
ꢀꢀSET MENU  
;AUTO SETUP  
AMP  
. ;MANUAL SETUPꢀꢀꢀ  
. ;SIGNAL INFO  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
ENTER  
SOURCE  
TV  
1
A-E/CAT.  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
1,7  
ENTER  
2-6  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
XM MEMORY  
Press ENTER to enter “MANUAL SETUP”.  
The “MANUAL SETUP” display appears in the  
OSD.  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
8
5
6
7
NIGHT ENHANCER  
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
PRESET/CH  
y
;MANUAL SETUP  
.ꢀ1ꢀBASICꢀMENU  
ꢀꢀ2ꢀSOUNDꢀMENU  
ꢀꢀ3ꢀINPUTꢀMENU  
ꢀꢀ4ꢀOPTIONꢀMENU  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
You can change the “SET MENU” parameters while this unit is  
reproducing sound.  
• If you press PARAMETER during the “SET MENU” operation,  
the “SET MENU” operation is canceled.  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
• Repeat the following procedure to select and adjust each  
parameter setting.  
• Press RETURN or lto return to the previous menu level.  
y
You can also press hto enter the selected menu item.  
Note  
You cannot change some “SET MENU” parameters when  
“NIGHT:CINEMA” or “NIGHT:MUSIC” is selected as the night  
listening mode (see page 52).  
4
Press k/ nrepeatedly and then press ENTER  
to select and enter the desired menu.  
The following displays are examples where “SOUND  
MENU” is selected.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SET MENU to enter “SET MENU”.  
The top “SET MENU” display appears in the OSD.  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
AMP  
ENTER  
ENTER  
SET MENU  
SOURCE  
A-E/CAT.  
MENU  
A-E/CAT.  
SRCH MODE  
TV  
2 SOUND MENU 1/2  
. A)EQUALIZER  
2 SOUND MENU 2/2  
. E)HDMI SET  
ꢀꢀSET MENU  
.;AUTOꢀSETUP  
;MANUALꢀSETUP  
.;SIGNALꢀINFO  
B)LFE LEVEL  
C)DYNAMIC RANGE  
D)AUDIO SET  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
ꢀꢀ[ ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
85 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
1 BASIC MENU  
Use this menu to manually adjust any speaker settings.  
5
Press k/ nrepeatedly and then press ENTER  
to select and enter the desired submenu.  
The following display is an example where “LFE  
LEVEL” is selected.  
2 BASIC MENU  
. A)SPEAKERꢀSET  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
B)SPꢀLEVEL  
C)SPꢀDISTANCE  
D)TESTꢀTONE  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
A-E/CAT.  
Speaker settings A)SPEAKER SET  
Use this feature to manually adjust any speaker settings.  
B)LFE LEVEL  
.ꢀSPEAKER;;;;;;0dB  
ꢀꢀHEADPHONE;;;;0dB  
y
• If you are not satisfied with the bass sounds from your speakers,  
you can change these settings according to your preference.  
• When the diameter of the woofer section of the speaker unit is  
larger than 16 cm (6.5 in), set the correspondent speaker setting  
parameter to “LARGE” (or “LRG”).  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p
[
LFE/Bass out LFE/BASS OUT  
6
Press k/ nto select the desired parameter  
and then l/ hto change the parameter  
settings.  
• Press hto increase the value.  
• Press lto decrease the value.  
Use this feature to select the speakers that output the LFE  
(low-frequency effect) and the low-frequency signals.  
Choices: SWFR, FRONT, BOTH  
LFE/BASS OUT  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
ENTER  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀSWFRꢀFRONT[BOTH  
A-E/CAT.  
A-E/CAT.  
Select “SWFR” (subwoofer) if you connected a  
subwoofer. The LFE signals as well as the low-  
frequency signals of other speakers set to “SML” (or  
“SMALL”) are directed to the subwoofer.  
Select “FRONT” (front) if you did not connect a  
subwoofer. The LFE signals, the low-frequency signals  
of the front left and right channels, and the low-  
frequency signals of other speakers set to “SML” (or  
“SMALL”) are all directed to the front left and right  
speakers regardless of the “FRONT SP” setting (see  
page 86).  
7
Press SET MENU to exit from “SET MENU”.  
SET MENU  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
Select “BOTH” (both) if you connected a subwoofer.  
The low-frequency signals of any source are output  
from the subwoofer. The LFE signals as well as the  
low-frequency signals of other speakers set to “SML”  
(or “SMALL”) are directed to the subwoofer. The low-  
frequency signals of the front left and right channels  
are directed to the front left and right speakers and the  
subwoofer regardless of the “FRONT SP” setting (see  
page 86).  
86 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Front speakers FRONT SP  
Choices: SMALL, LARGE  
Surround left/right speakers SUR. L/R SP  
Choices: NONE, SML, LRG  
SUR. L/R SP  
FRONT SP  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀNONEꢀꢀSMLꢀꢀLRG  
[
ꢀꢀ ꢀꢀ SMALLꢀ[ꢀLARGE  
Select “NONE” (none) if you did not connect surround  
speakers. This unit is set to the Virtual CINEMA DSP  
mode (see page 48) and “SB L/R SP” is automatically  
set to “NONE”.  
Select “SML” (small) if you have small surround left  
and right speakers that do not reproduce low-frequency  
signals effectively. The low-frequency signals of the  
surround left and right channels are directed to the  
speakers selected in “LFE/BASS OUT”.  
Select “LRG” (large) if you have large surround left  
and right speakers that reproduce low-frequency  
signals effectively. All the surround channel signals are  
directed to the surround left and right speakers.  
Select “SMALL” (small) if you have small front  
speakers that do not reproduce low-frequency signals  
effectively. The low-frequency signals of the front left  
and right channels are directed to the speakers selected  
in “LFE/BASS OUT” (see page 86).  
Select “LARGE” (large) if you have large front  
speakers that reproduce low-frequency signals  
effectively. All the front left and right channel signals  
are directed to the front left and right speakers.  
Notes  
• When “LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “FRONT” (see page 86), the  
LFE signals found in Dolby Digital or DTS sources, the low-  
frequency signals of the front left and right channels, and the  
low-frequency signals of other speakers set to “SML” (or  
“SMALL”) are all directed to the front left and right speakers  
regardless of the “FRONT SP” setting.  
• When “LFE/BASS OUT” is set to “FRONT” (see page 86), you  
can select only “LARGE” in “FRONT SP”. If the value of  
“FRONT SP” is set to other than “LARGE” in advance, this  
unit changes the value to “LARGE” automatically.  
Center speaker CENTER SP  
Choices: NONE, SML, LRG  
CENTER SP  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀNONEꢀ[ꢀSMLꢀꢀLRG  
Select “NONE” (none) if you did not connect a center  
speaker. The center channel signals are directed to the  
front left and right speakers.  
Select “SML” (small) if you have a small center  
speaker that does not reproduce low-frequency signals  
effectively. The low-frequency signals of the center  
channel are directed to the speakers selected in “LFE/  
BASS OUT”.  
Select “LRG” (large) if you have a large center speaker  
that reproduces low-frequency signals effectively. All  
the center channel signals are directed to the center  
speaker.  
87 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Surround back speakers SB L/R SP  
Bass cross over CROSS OVER  
Choices: NONE, SMLx1, SMLx2, LRGx1, LRGx2  
Use this feature to select the crossover frequency of all the  
speakers set to “SML” (or “SMALL”) or to “NONE” in  
“SPEAKER SET” (see pages 86 and 88). All frequencies  
below the selected frequency will be sent to the subwoofer  
or to the speakers set to “LRG” (or “LARGE”) in  
“SPEAKER SET” (see pages 86 and 88).  
ꢀꢀꢀSB L/R SP  
Choices: 40Hz, 60Hz, 80Hz, 90Hz, 100Hz, 110Hz,  
120Hz, 160Hz, 200Hz  
SMLx1 ꢀSMLx2  
[
Select “NONE” (none) if you did not connect surround  
back speakers. The surround back channel signals are  
directed to the surround left and right speakers.  
Select “SMLx1” (small x 1) if you have a small  
surround back speaker that does not reproduce low-  
frequency signals effectively. The low-frequency  
signals of the surround back left and right channels are  
directed to the speakers selected in “LFE/BASS OUT”  
and the rest of the signals are directed to the surround  
back left speaker.  
Select “SMLx2” (small x 2) if you have two small  
surround back speakers that do not reproduce low-  
frequency signals effectively. The low-frequency  
signals of the surround back left and right channels are  
directed to the speakers selected in “LFE/BASS OUT”.  
Select “LRGx1” (large x 1) if you have a large  
surround back speaker that reproduces low-frequency  
signals effectively. All the surround back left and right  
channel signals are directed to the surround back left  
speaker.  
CROSS OVER  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀFREQ;;;80Hz  
Subwoofer phase SUBWOOFER PHASE  
Use this feature to switch the phase of your subwoofer if  
bass sounds are lacking or unclear.  
Choices: NORMAL, REVERSE  
02ASUBWOOFER PHASE  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀNORMALꢀꢀREVERSE  
[
Select “NORMAL” if you do not want to reverse the  
phase of your subwoofer.  
Select “REVERSE” to reverse the phase of your  
subwoofer.  
Select “LRGx2” (large x 2) if you have two large  
surround back speakers that reproduce low-frequency  
signals effectively. All the surround back left and right  
channel signals are directed to the surround back left  
and right speakers.  
Presence/Surround back channel priority  
PRIORITY  
Presence speakers PRESENCE SP  
Use this feature if you want to use the presence speakers  
connected to this unit.  
Use this feature to prioritize either the presence or the  
surround back speakers when playing sources that contain  
surround back channel signals using the CINEMA DSP  
sound field programs.  
Choices: NONE, YES  
Choices: PRNS, SB  
PRESENCE SP  
PRIORITY  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀNONEꢀꢀꢀYES  
[
PRNS ꢀSB  
[
Select “NONE” (none) if you did not connect presence  
speakers.  
Select “YES” (yes) if you connected presence speakers  
and want to use them.  
Select “PRNS” to use the presence speakers even when  
surround back channel signals are input. The signals  
for the surround back channel will be output from the  
surround speakers.  
Select “SB” to use the surround back speakers when  
surround back channel signals are detected in a  
CINEMA DSP program. The presence channel signals  
are output from the front speakers.  
88 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Speaker level B)SP LEVEL  
Use this feature to manually balance the speaker levels  
between the front left or surround left speakers and each  
speaker selected in “SPEAKER SET” (see page 86).  
Control range: –10.0 to +10.0 dB  
Control step: 0.5 dB  
Initial setting:  
FR. L/FR. R/SWFR/PR. L/PR. R: 0 dB  
CENT./SUR. L/SUR. R/SB L/SB R: –1.0 dB  
Speaker distance C)SP DISTANCE  
Use this feature to manually adjust the distance of each  
speaker and the delay applied to the respective channel.  
Ideally, each speaker should be the same distance from the  
main listening position. However, this is not possible in  
most home situations. Thus, a certain amount of delay  
must be applied to the sound from each speaker so that all  
sounds will arrive at the listening position at the same  
time.  
B)SP LEVEL  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀFR.Lꢀ;;;;;;;;;;  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀFR.Rꢀ;;;;;;;;;;  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀCENT.;;;;;;;;;;  
C)SP DISTANCE  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀ -__________+  
ꢀꢀ. UNIT;;;;;;;;feet  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀFRONTꢀL;;;10.0ft  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀFRONTꢀR;;;10.0ft  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀCENTER;;;;ꢀ8.5ft  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p
[
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[p]/[[]:Adjust  
Select “FR. L” to adjust the balance of the front left  
speaker.  
Select “FR. R” to adjust the balance of the front right  
speaker.  
Select “CENT.” to adjust the balance of the center  
speaker.  
Select “SUR. L” to adjust the balance of the surround  
left speaker.  
Select “SUR. R” to adjust the balance of the surround  
right speaker.  
Select “SB L” to adjust the balance of the surround  
back left speaker.  
Select “SB R” to adjust the balance of the surround  
back right speaker.  
Unit UNIT  
Choices: meters (m), feet (ft)  
Initial setting:  
[U.S.A. and Canada models]: feet (ft)  
[Other models]: meters (m)  
Select “meters” to adjust speaker distances in meters.  
Select “feet” to adjust speaker distances in feet.  
Speaker distances  
Control range: 0.30 to 24.00 m (1.0 to 80.0 ft)  
Control step: 0.10 m (0.5 ft)  
Initial setting:  
FRONT L/FRONT R/SWFR/PRNS L/  
PRNS R: 3.00m (10.0ft)  
Select “SWFR” to adjust the balance of the subwoofer.  
Select “PR. L” to adjust the balance of the presence left  
speaker.  
Select “PR. R” to adjust the balance of the presence  
right speaker.  
CENTER: 2.60m (8.5ft)  
SUR. L/SUR. R/SB L/SB R: 2.40m (8.0ft)  
Select “FRONT L” to adjust the distance of the front  
left speaker.  
Select “FRONT R” to adjust the distance of the front  
right speaker.  
Select “CENTER” to adjust the distance of the center  
speaker.  
Select “SUR. L” to adjust the distance of the surround  
left speaker.  
Select “SUR. R” to adjust the distance of the surround  
right speaker.  
Select “SB L” to adjust the distance of the surround  
back left speaker.  
Select “SB R” to adjust the distance of the surround  
back right speaker.  
Notes  
• “CENT.”, “SUR. L”, “SUR. R”, “SB L”, “SB R”, “SWFR”,  
“PR. L” and “PR. R” cannot be adjusted if “CENTER SP” (see  
page 87), “SUR. L/R SP” (see page 87), “SB.L/R SP” (see  
page 88), “LFE/BASS OUT” (see page 86) and “PRESENCE  
SP” (see page 88) are set to “NONE” respectively.  
• Instead of “SB L” and “SB R”, “SB” is displayed if “SB.L/R  
SP” is set to either “SMLx1” or “LRGx1” (see page 88).  
Select “SWFR” to adjust the distance of the subwoofer.  
Select “PRNS L” to adjust the distance of the presence  
left speaker.  
Select “PRNS R” to adjust the distance of the presence  
right speaker.  
89 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Notes  
2 SOUND MENU  
• “CENTER”, “SUR. L”, “SUR. R”, “SB L”, “SB R”, “SWFR”,  
“PRNS L” and “PRNS R” cannot be adjusted if “CENTER SP”  
(see page 87), “SUR. L/R SP” (see page 87), “SB L/R SP” (see  
page 88), “LFE/BASS OUT” (see page 86) and “PRESENCE  
SP” (see page 88) are set to “NONE” respectively.  
Use to manually adjust speaker settings or compensate for  
video signal processing delays when using LCD monitors  
or projectors. Most of the SOUND MENU parameters are  
set automatically when you run AUTO SETUP (see  
page 31).  
• Instead of “SB L” and “SB R”, “SB” is displayed if “SB L/R  
SP” is set to either “SMLx1” or “LRGx1” (see page 88).  
2 SOUND MENU 1/2  
. A)EQUALIZER  
2 SOUND MENU 2/2  
. E)HDMI SET  
Test tone D)TEST TONE  
B)LFE LEVEL  
Turns the test tone output on or off for the SPEAKER  
SET, SP LEVEL and SP DISTANCE settings.  
Choices: ON, OFF  
C)DYNAMIC RANGE  
D)AUDIO SET  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
D)TEST TONE  
TEST TONE;;;;OFF  
Equalizer A)EQUALIZER  
Use this feature to select the parametric equalizer or the  
graphic equalizer.  
[) ]/[)]:Select  
Equalizer select SELECT  
Use this feature to select the type of equalizer.  
Choices: AUTO PEQ, GEQ, EQ OFF  
y
If you use a handheld sound pressure level meter, hold at arm’s  
length and point upwards so that the meter is in the listening  
position. With the meter set to the 70 dB scale and to C SLOW,  
calibrate each speaker to 75 dB.  
A)EQUALIZER  
SELECT;;;;;;;ꢀGEQ  
Notes  
ꢀꢀꢀ[) ]/[)]:Adjust  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
• This function is automatically turned off if you exit “BASIC  
MENU”.  
• If you select “ON” and enter the “SPEAKER SET”, “SP  
LEVEL” or “SP DISTANCE” menu, the test tone is output from  
the selected speakers.  
Select “AUTO PEQ” to use the parametric equalizer  
adjusted in “AUTO SETUP” (see page 31).  
Select “GEQ” to adjust the built-in 7-frequency band  
graphic equalizer so that the tonal quality of the  
speaker matches. Press ENTER to display the graphic  
equalizer screen.  
Select “EQ OFF” to deactivate the equalizing feature.  
Note  
You can select “AUTO PEQ” only when you carry out “AUTO  
SETUP” in advance (see page 31). In this case, “AUTO PEQ” is  
automatically selected as the default setting.  
90 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.ꢀCHANNE  
                                            
                                                 
ꢀCHANNE  
                                            
                                                 
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Graphic equalizer GEQ  
Low-frequency effect level  
B)LFE LEVEL  
Use to match the tonal quality of the center, surround L/R  
and surround back L/R, surround back, presence L/R  
speakers and the subwoofer with that of the front L/R  
speakers. You can adjust 7 frequency bands (63Hz,  
160Hz, 400Hz, 1kHz, 2.5kHz, 6.3kHz, 16kHz).  
Choices: –6.0 to +6.0 dB  
Use this feature to adjust the output level of the LFE (low-  
frequency effect) channel according to the capacity of  
your subwoofer or headphones. The LFE channel carries  
low-frequency special effects which are only added to  
certain scenes. This setting is effective only when this unit  
decodes Dolby Digital or DTS signals.  
Control step: 0.5 dB  
Control range: –20 to 0 dB  
Control step: 1 dB  
A)EQUALIZER  
;;F ONTꢀL  
-______+  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀ  
ꢀꢀꢀ63Hz ;;;;;;  
ꢀꢀ160Hz ;;;;;;  
ꢀꢀ400Hz ;;;;;;  
ꢀꢀ  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
0.0dB  
B)LFE LEVEL  
.ꢀSPEAKER;;;;;;0dB  
ꢀꢀHEADPHONE;;;;0dB  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p
[
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
y
p
[
Press k/ nto select a frequency band and l/ hto adjust the  
selected frequency band.  
Speaker SPEAKER  
Note  
Adjusts the speaker LFE level.  
The “GEQ” parameter can be adjusted only when “GEQ” is  
selected in “SELECT”.  
Headphone HEADPHONE  
Adjusts the headphone LFE level.  
Test tone TEST TONE  
Note  
A)EQUALIZER  
;;F ONTꢀL  
-______+  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀ  
Depending on the settings of “LFE/BASS OUT” (see page 86),  
some signals may not be output at the SUBWOOFER OUTPUT  
jack.  
ꢀꢀ16kHz ;;;;;;  
0.0dB  
ꢀꢀ  
ꢀꢀ  
. TESTꢀTONE;;;;OFF  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
Dynamic range C)DYNAMIC RANGE  
Use this feature to select the amount of dynamic range  
compression to be applied to your speakers or  
headphones. This setting is effective only when this unit is  
decoding Dolby Digital and DTS signals.  
p
[
Use this feature to make adjustments of “GEQ” while  
listening to a test tone. To select “TEST TONE”, press n  
repeatedly in the graphic equalizer screen.  
Choices: OFF, ON  
Choices: MIN, STD, MAX  
Select “OFF” to stop test tones and output the currently  
selected source component.  
Select “ON” to output test tones from the selected  
speakers.  
Select “MIN” (minimum) if you regularly listen at low  
volume levels.  
Select “STD” (standard) for general use.  
Select “MAX” (maximum) to preserve the greatest  
amount of dynamic range.  
C)DYNAMIC RANGE  
.ꢀSP:ꢀMINꢀSTD[MAX  
ꢀꢀHP:ꢀMINꢀSTD[MAX  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Select  
p
[
Speaker SP  
Adjusts the speaker compression.  
Headphone HP  
Adjusts the headphone compression.  
91 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Audio settings D)AUDIO SET  
Use this feature to adjust the overall audio settings of this  
unit.  
HDMI set E)HDMI SET  
Use this feature to select the component to play back  
HDMI audio signals.  
E)HDMI SET  
D)AUDIO SET  
SUPPORT AUDIO:  
HTR-6090  
. MUTE TYPE;;;FULL  
A.DELAY;;;;;;0ms  
TONE BYPASS;AUTO  
LE>E  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p [  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p
[
Support audio SUPPORT AUDIO  
Muting type MUTING TYPE  
Use to select whether to play back HDMI audio signals on  
this unit or on another HDMI component connected to the  
HDMI OUT jack on the rear panel of this unit.  
Choices: HTR-6090, OTHER  
Use this feature to adjust how much the mute function  
reduces the output volume (see page 40).  
Choices: FULL, –20dB  
Select “FULL” to completely mute all the audio  
Select “HTR-6090” to play back HDMI audio signals  
on this unit. The HDMI audio signals input at the  
HDMI IN jacks of this unit are not output to the HDMI  
component connected to the HDMI OUT jack on the  
rear panel of this unit.  
Select “OTHER” to play back HDMI audio signals on  
another HDMI component connected to the HDMI  
OUT jack.  
output.  
Select “–20dB” to reduce the current volume by 20 dB.  
Audio delay AUDIO DELAY  
Use this feature to delay the sound output and synchronize  
it with the video image. This may be necessary when  
using certain LCD monitors or projectors.  
Control range: 0 to 240 ms  
Control step: 1 ms  
Note  
Tone bypass TONE BYPASS  
Use this feature to select whether the audio output  
bypasses the tone control circuitry when “TREBLE” and  
“BASS” are set to 0 dB (see page 49).  
Choices: AUTO, OFF  
The HDMI video signals input at the HDMI IN 1 or HDMI IN 2  
jack of this unit are always output at the HDMI OUT jack of this  
unit.  
Select “AUTO” if you want the signals to bypass the  
tone control circuitry to provide the purest signal  
possible.  
Select “OFF” if you do not want the signals to bypass  
the tone control circuitry.  
92 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
For COAXIAL INPUT jacks 1, 2 and 3 COAXIAL IN  
Choices: (1) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, DVD,  
DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2, V-  
AUX, MULTI CH  
3 INPUT MENU  
Use this menu to reassign the input/output jacks, select the  
input mode or rename the input source.  
(2) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, DVD,  
DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2, V-  
AUX, MULTI CH  
(3) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, DVD,  
DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2, V-  
AUX, MULTI CH  
3 INPUT MENU 1/2  
. A)I/OꢀASSIGNMENT  
B)INPUT RENAME  
C)VOLUME TRIM  
D)DECODER MODE  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
3 INPUT MENU 2/2  
. E)MULTI CH SET  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀCOAXIALIN  
Input/output assignment A)I/O  
ASSIGNMENT  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀ(1);;;;;  
CD  
CD  
ꢀꢀ (2);;;;; DVD  
DVD  
(
)
)
(
Use this feature to assign the input/output jacks according  
to the component to be used if the initial settings of this  
unit do not correspond to your needs. Change the  
following parameters to reassign the respective jacks and  
effectively connect more components.  
Once the input/output jacks are reassigned, you can select  
the corresponding component by using the INPUT  
selector on the front panel (or the input selector buttons on  
the remote control).  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ(3);;;;;DVR/VCR2  
(DVR/VCR2)  
For OPTICAL INPUT jacks 4, 5, 6 and 7  
IN  
OPTICAL  
Choices: (4) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, DVD,  
DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2,  
MULTI CH  
y
(5) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, DVD,  
DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2,  
MULTI CH  
The input source name in parentheses indicates the default  
assigned input source.  
(6) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, DVD,  
DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2,  
MULTI CH  
(7) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, DVD,  
DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2,  
MULTI CH  
For COMPONENT VIDEO jacks A, B and C  
CMPNT-V IN  
Choices: [A] DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR  
2, V-AUX  
[B] DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR  
2, V-AUX  
[C] DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR  
2, V-AUX  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀOPTICALINꢀ2/2  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀ(7);;;;;CBL/SAT  
(CBL/SATꢀ)  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀOPTICALINꢀ1/2  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀ(4);;;;;ꢀꢀꢀCD  
(ꢀꢀꢀCDꢀꢀꢀ)  
(5);;;;; DVD  
ꢀꢀꢀ(ꢀꢀDVD ꢀꢀ)  
(6);;;;;ꢀꢀDTV  
ꢀꢀꢀ(ꢀꢀDTVꢀꢀꢀ)  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀCMPNT-VINPUT  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀ[A];;;;;ꢀꢀDVD  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀ(ꢀꢀDVDꢀꢀꢀ)  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[B];;;;;ꢀꢀDTV  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀ(ꢀꢀDTVꢀꢀꢀ)  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[C];;;;;CBL/SAT  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀ(CBL/SATꢀ)  
93 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
For OPTICAL OUTPUT jacks 8 and 9 OPTICAL  
OUT  
1
2
Press one of the input selector buttons on  
the remote control to select the input source  
you want to change the name of.  
Choices: (8) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, DVD,  
DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2, V-  
AUX  
XM  
(9) MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, PHONO, DVD,  
DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2, V-  
AUX  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀOPTICALOUT  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀ(8);;;;;MD/TAPE  
(MD/TAPE )  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ(9);;;;;;;CD-R  
(ꢀꢀCD-Rꢀꢀ)  
Press l/ hon the remote control to place  
the “_” (underscore) under the space or the  
character you want to edit.  
PRESET/CH  
Notes  
You cannot select a specific item more than once for the same  
type of jack.  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
• When you connect a component to both the DIGITAL INPUT  
(COAXIAL) and DIGITAL INPUT (OPTICAL) jacks, priority  
is given to the signals input at the DIGITAL INPUT  
(COAXIAL) jack.  
3
Press k/ nto select the character you want  
to use and then press l/ hto move to the  
next space.  
For HDMI IN jacks 1 and 2  
HDMI IN  
Choices: [IN1] DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/  
VCR 2, V-AUX  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
[IN2] DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/  
VCR 2, V-AUX  
ENTER  
ENTER  
HDMI IN  
.ꢀ[IN1];;; DVD  
A-E/CAT.  
A-E/CAT.  
(
[IN2];;;CBL/SAT  
DVD  
)
(CBL/SAT)  
Notes  
You can use up to 8 characters for each input.  
• Press nto change the character in the following order, or  
press kto go in the reverse order:  
Input rename B) INPUT RENAME  
Use this feature to change the name of the input source  
that appears in the OSD and in the front panel display.  
A to Z, 0 to 9, a to z, symbols (#, *, –, +, etc.) space.  
4
5
Repeat steps 1 through 3 to rename each  
input source.  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀC)INPUTRENAME  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀDVDꢀ->ꢀꢀ DVD  
________  
Press SET MENU on the remote control to  
exit from “INPUT RENAME”.  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[p]/[[]:Position  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Chara.  
SET MENU  
MENU  
y
SRCH MODE  
• This feature is useful when you change the input or output  
assignment for digital jacks and component video input jacks.  
You can also change the name of the input source that appears  
in the display window on the remote control. Refer to  
“Changing source names in the display window” on page 105.  
94 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Volume Trim C)VOLUME TRIM  
Use this feature to adjust the level of the signal input at  
each jack. This is useful if you want to balance the level of  
each input source to avoid sudden changes in volume  
when switching between input sources.  
Choices: XM, TUNER, PHONO, CD, CD-R, MD/TAPE,  
DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2, V-  
AUX, DOCK  
Multi channel input Setup  
E)MULTI CH SET  
Use to set the direction of the signals input into the center,  
subwoofer and surround channels when a source  
component is connected to the MULTI CH INPUT jacks.  
If you input 8-channel signals from an external decoder,  
use this feature to select jacks for the additional front  
signals.  
Control range: –6.0 to +6.0 dB  
Control step: 0.5 dB  
Initial setting: 0.0 dB  
E)MULTI CH SET  
. BGV;;;;;;;;;LAST  
INPUTꢀCH;;;;;6CH  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀC)VOLUME TRIM  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p
[
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀXMꢀꢀꢀ;;;0.0dB  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀTUNERꢀꢀ;;;0.0dB  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀPHONOꢀꢀ;;;0.0dB  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀCDꢀꢀꢀ;;;0.0dB  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p
[
BGV BGV  
Use this feature to select the video source played in the  
background of the sources input from the MULTI CH  
INPUT jacks.  
y
This parameter also affects the signals output at ZONE OUT  
Choices: DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT, VCR 1, DVR/VCR 2,  
jacks.  
V-AUX, LAST, OFF  
Select “LAST” to set this unit to automatically select  
the last selected video source as the background video  
source.  
Select “OFF” to set this unit not to play the video  
source in the background.  
Decoder mode D)DECODER MODE  
Use to switch the input mode. You can designate the  
reassigned digital input jacks for specific audio signals  
(DTS, etc.).  
Choices: AUTO, DTS  
Input channels INPUT CH  
Use this setting to select the number of channels input  
from an external decoder.  
D)DECODER MODE  
.
CD ;;;;AUTO  
DVD ;;;;AUTO  
DTV ;;;;AUTO  
Choices: 6CH, 8CH  
Select “6CH” if you input 6-channel signals.  
CBL/SAT ;;;;AUTO  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
Select “8CH” if you input 8-channel signals.  
p
[
Note  
Select “AUTO” if you want this unit to automatically  
detect input signal types and select the appropriate  
input mode.  
Select “DTS” if you want this unit to select DTS as the  
input mode.  
If “ZONE2 AMP” is set to “[SP1]” (see page 99), no sound is  
output from the surround back speakers even if you select “8CH”.  
In this case, select “6CH” and set the output setting of the  
external component to 6 channels.  
Front input FRONT  
E)MULTI CH SET  
BGV;;;;;;;;;LAST  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀINPUTꢀCH;;;;;8CH  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀFRONT;;;;;;;;DVD  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p
[
If you selected 8ch in “INPUT CH”, you can select the  
analog jacks at which the front signals from an external  
decoder will be input.  
Choices: MD/TAPE, CD-R, CD, DVD, DTV, CBL/SAT,  
VCR1, DVR/VCR2, V-AUX  
Note  
“FRONT” parameter appears only when you set “INPUT CH” to  
“8CH”.  
95 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Gray back GRAY BACK  
4 OPTION MENU  
Use this menu to adjust the optional system parameters.  
Use this feature to display a gray background in your  
video monitor when there is no video signal being input.  
Choices: AUTO, OFF  
Select “AUTO” to display a gray background in your  
video monitor when there is no video signal being  
input.  
4 OPTION MENU 1/2  
4 OPTION MENU 2/2  
. A)DISPLAYꢀSET  
B)MEMORY GUARD  
C)AUDIO SELECT  
. E)PARAM. INI  
F)ZONE SET  
Select “OFF” not to display a gray background in your  
video monitor.  
G)XM RADIO SET  
H)DOCKꢀSET  
D)DECODER MODE  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Enter  
Notes  
• Depending on the video signals being input or the system  
setting of your video monitor (NTSC or PAL), the OSD may be  
displayed abnormally. In such cases, set “GRAY BACK” to  
“OFF”.  
• Even when “GRAY BACK” is set to “OFF”, the OSD may not  
be displayed correctly depending on the conditions of the  
picture.  
Display settings A)DISPLAY SET  
Note  
Use the “V-RESET” in “ADVANCED SETUP” to set the  
parameters in “DISPLAY SET” (except “DIMMER”, “SHORT  
MESSAGE”, “ON SCREEN” and “FL SCROLL”) to the factory  
presets (see page 119).  
Video conversion V CONV.  
Use this feature to set whether to convert the video signals  
input at the VIDEO, S VIDEO and COMPONENT  
VIDEO jacks.  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀA)DISPLAYSET  
Choices: ON, OFF  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀDIMMER;;;;;;;;;;0  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀOSD SHIFT;;;;;;;0  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀGRAYꢀBACK;;;;AUTO  
VꢀCONV.;;;;;;;;ON  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ  
Select “ON” to convert composite, S-video and  
component video signals interchangeably and up-  
convert composite and S-video and component video  
signals to HDMI video signals.  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p
[
Select “OFF” not to convert any signals.  
Dimmer DIMMER  
Notes  
Use this feature to adjust the brightness of the front panel  
display.  
• This unit does not convert 480 line video signals and 576 line  
video signals interchangeably.  
Control range: 4 to 0  
Control step: 1  
• The analog component video signals with 480i (NTSC)/576i  
(PAL) of resolution are converted to the s-video or composite  
video signals and output at the S VIDEO MONITOR OUT and  
VIDEO MONITOR OUT jacks.  
Press lto make the front panel display dimmer.  
Press hto make the front panel display brighter.  
• The converted video signals are only output at the MONITOR  
OUT jacks. When recording a video source, you must make the  
same type of video connections between each component.  
• When composite video or S-video signals from a VCR are  
converted to component video signals, the picture quality may  
suffer depending on your VCR.  
• Set “V CONV.” to “ON” to display the sound field parameter  
display and short message display.  
• Unconventional signals input at the composite video or S-video  
jacks cannot be converted or may be output abnormally. In such  
cases, set “V CONV.” to “OFF”.  
OSD shift OSD SHIFT  
Use this feature to adjust the vertical position of the OSD.  
Control range: –5 (upward) to +5 (downward)  
Control step: 1  
Initial setting: 0  
Press lto raise the position of the OSD.  
Press hto lower the position of the OSD.  
• When non-standard video signals (such as video signals from a  
game console) are input, this unit may not convert the signals  
even if you set “V CONV.” to “ON”.  
96 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Component interlace/progressive up-conversion  
CMPNT I/P  
Short message display SHORT MESSAGE  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the short message  
display function.  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the analog  
interlace/progressive conversion of the analog video  
signals input at the composite video, S-video and  
component video jacks so that the analog video signals  
deinterlaced from 480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) to 480p/576p  
are output at the COMPONENT MONITOR OUT jacks.  
Choices: ON, OFF  
Choices: ON, OFF  
Select “ON” to activate the short message display  
function. The contents of the front panel display appear  
at the bottom of the screen each time you operate this  
unit.  
Select “OFF” to deactivate the short message display  
function.  
Select “ON” to activate the analog interlace/  
progressive up-conversion of the analog video signals.  
Select “OFF” to deactivate the analog interlace/  
progressive up-conversion of the analog video signals.  
Note  
The short message display does not appear in the following cases:  
– when the component video signals with 480p/576p, 720p,  
1080i or 1080p resolutions are input  
Notes  
– when HDMI video signals are input  
• This menu item is not available and hence not visible in the  
OSD if “V CONV.” is set to “OFF”.  
On-screen display time ON SCREEN  
Use this feature to set the amount of time to display the  
XM Satellite Radio information or iPod menu in the OSD  
after you perform a certain operation.  
• If your video monitor does not support analog video signals  
with 480p/576p of resolution, the SET MENU items may not be  
displayed on your video monitor when “CMPNT I/P” is set to  
“ON”. Use “V-RESET” in “ADVANCED SETUP” to set the  
“CMPNT I/P” parameter to the factory preset setting (see  
page 119).  
Choices: ALWAYS, 10SEC, 30SEC  
Select “ALWAYS” to display the OSD unceasingly  
during an operation.  
Select “10SEC” to turn off the OSD 10 seconds after  
you perform a certain operation.  
Select “30SEC” to turn off the OSD 30 seconds after  
you perform a certain operation.  
HDMI interlace/progressive up-conversion  
HDMI I/P  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the HDMI  
interlace/progressive up-conversion of the analog video  
signals input at the composite video, S-video and  
component video jacks so that the analog video signals  
deinterlaced from 480i (NTSC)/576i (PAL) to 480p/576p  
are output at the HDMI OUT jack.  
Front panel display scroll FL SCROLL  
Use this feature to set whether to display the information  
(such as song title or channel name) in the front panel  
display in a continuous manner or by the first 14  
alphanumeric characters after scrolling all characters once  
when “XM” or “DOCK” is selected as the input source.  
Choices: CONT, ONCE  
Choices: ON, OFF  
Select “ON” to activate the HDMI interlace/  
progressive up-conversion of the analog video signals.  
Select “OFF” to deactivate the HDMI interlace/  
progressive up-conversion of the analog video signals.  
Select “CONT” to display the operation status in the  
front panel display in a continuous manner.  
Select “ONCE” to display the operation status in the  
front panel display by the first 14 alphanumeric  
characters after scrolling all characters once.  
Notes  
• This menu item is not available and hence not visible in the  
OSD if “V CONV.” is set to “OFF”.  
• When analog video signals with 1080i or 720p of resolution are  
up-converted to HDMI and output at the HDMI OUT jack, the  
picture quality may worsen.  
97 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Memory guard B)MEMORY GUARD  
Use this feature to prevent accidental changes to DSP  
program parameter values and other system settings.  
Choices: OFF, ON  
Decoder mode D)DECODER MODE  
Use this feature to designate the default decoder mode for  
the input sources connected to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks  
when you turn on the power of this unit.  
Choices: AUTO, LAST  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀB)MEMORYGUARD  
D)DECODER MODE  
[AUTO LAST  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀꢀOFFꢀꢀꢀON  
[
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
p [  
ꢀꢀꢀ[p]/[[]:Adjust  
ꢀꢀꢀ  
Select “OFF” to turn off the “MEMORY GUARD”  
feature.  
Select “ON” to protect:  
– DSP sound field program parameters  
– all “SET MENU” items  
– all speaker levels  
Select “AUTO” to if you want this unit to  
automatically detect the type of input signals and select  
the appropriate decoder mode.  
Select “LAST” to if you want this unit to automatically  
select the last decoder mode used the connected input  
source.  
Note  
Note  
When “MEMORY GUARD” is set to “ON”, you cannot select  
and adjust any other “SET MENU” items.  
Selecting “LAST” does not recall the last setting for the EXTD  
SUR. button on the remote control.  
Audio select C)AUDIO SELECT  
Use this feature to designate the default input mode for the  
input sources connected to the DIGITAL INPUT jacks  
when you turn on the power of this unit.  
Parameter initialization E)PARAM.INI  
Use this feature to initialize the parameters of each sound  
field program within a sound field program group. When  
you initialize a sound field program group, all of the  
parameter values within that group revert to their initial  
factory settings.  
Press the corresponding sound field program selector  
buttons on the remote control to select the sound field  
program that you want to initialize.  
Choices: AUTO, LAST  
C)AUDIO SELECT  
[AUTO LAST  
ꢀꢀꢀ[p]/[[]:Adjust  
ꢀꢀꢀ  
An asterisk (*) appears to the left of the sound field  
program names that have been changed from their initial  
factory settings.  
Select “AUTO” if you want this unit to automatically  
detect the type of input signals and select the  
appropriate input mode.  
Select “LAST” if you want this unit to automatically  
select the last input mode used for the connected input  
source.  
Choices: CLASSICAL, LIVE/CLUB,  
ENTERTAINMENT, MOVIE, STEREO,  
SURROUND DECODE  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀE)PARAM.INI  
CLASSICAL  
*LIVE/CLUB  
ENTERTAINMENT  
*MOVIE  
Note  
Selecting “LAST” does not recall the last setting for the EXTD  
SUR. button on the remote control.  
ꢀSTEREO  
ꢀSURROUNDꢀDECODE  
Press DSP key  
Notes  
You cannot automatically revert to the previous parameter  
settings once you initialize a sound field program group.  
You cannot separately initialize individual sound field  
programs.  
You cannot initialize any sound field program groups when  
“MEMORY GUARD” is set to “ON” (see page 98).  
98 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CUSTOMIZING THIS UNIT (MANUAL SETUP)  
Zone set F)ZONE SET  
XM Radio setting G)XM RADIO SET  
F)ZONE SET  
. ZONE2 VOL;;;;VAR  
ZONE2 AMP;;;;EXT  
G)XM RADIO SET  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀXM ANTENNA;;NONE  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Up/Down  
ꢀꢀꢀ[ꢀ]/[ꢀ]:Adjust  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ  
p
[
XM Radio antenna XM ANTENNA  
Zone 2 volume ZONE2 VOL  
Use this feature to check the current reception level of the  
XM Passport System connected to the XM jack of this  
unit (see page 60). For the best reception, orient the XM  
Passport System so that a value of 60% or more is  
displayed here.  
Use to select how the volume control will operate with  
regard to the ZONE 2 OUTPUT jacks.  
Choices: VAR, FIX  
Select “VAR” to adjust the ZONE 2 OUTPUT volume  
simultaneously with VOLUME +/– on the remote  
control.  
Display status: NONE, 0 to 100%  
Notes  
Select “FIX” to fix the ZONE 2 OUTPUT volume level  
to a standard line level.  
“NONE” is displayed if the XM Passport System is not connected to  
this unit. In this case, check the antenna connections (see page 60).  
Zone 2 amplifier ZONE2 AMP  
• The “XM ANTENNA” parameter cannot be adjusted by using  
the remote control. Instead, you need to adjust the orientation of  
the XM Passport System connected to the XM jack of this unit  
for a better percentage of the reception level.  
Use to select how the ZONE 2 speakers are amplified.  
Choices: EXT, [SP1]  
Select “EXT” if you want to connect your Zone 2  
speakers through an external amplifier connected to the  
ZONE 2 OUTPUT jacks on the rear panel of this unit.  
Select “[SP1]” to use the internal surround back  
amplifier of this unit when you want to connect your  
Zone 2 speakers directly to the SP1 speaker terminals  
on the rear panel of this unit.  
Dock set H)DOCK SET  
H)DOCK SET  
ꢀꢀ.ꢀSTANDBYꢀCHRG;AUTO  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[) ]/[)]:Adjust  
ꢀꢀꢀꢀ[ENTER]:Return  
Notes  
• When “BI-AMP” is set to “ON” in the “ADVANCED SETUP”  
menu, “[SP1]” cannot be selected.  
• When you use internal amplifiers for Zone 2, some surround  
field programs may not work in the same way as when you do  
not use the internal amplifiers for Zone 2.  
Charge on standby STANDBY CHRG  
Use this feature to select whether this unit charges the  
battery of the stationed iPod or not when this unit is in the  
standby mode (see page 72).  
Choices: AUTO, OFF  
Select “AUTO” to charge the battery of the stationed  
iPod when this unit is turned on and in the standby  
mode.  
Select “OFF” to charge the battery of the stationed  
iPod only when this unit is turned on.  
99 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
In addition to controlling this unit, the remote control can also operate other audiovisual components made by YAMAHA  
and other manufacturers. To control your TV or other components, you must set up the appropriate remote control code  
for each input source (see page 102).  
Controlling this unit, a TV, or other components  
Controlling this unit  
Controlling a TV  
Set the operation mode selector to AMP to control this  
Set the operation mode selector to TV to control your TV.  
To control your TV, you must set the appropriate remote  
control code for DTV or PHONO (see page 102). When  
you set the remote control codes for both DTV and  
PHONO, priority is given to the one set for DTV.  
unit (see page 6).  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
*1  
*1  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
*2  
*2  
*1  
*1  
PHONO  
TUNER  
PHONO  
TUNER  
-
V
-
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
V
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
SELECT  
SELECT  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
PRESET/CH  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
MENU  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
SRCH MODE  
ENTER  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
*1  
*2  
XM MEMORY  
XM MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
1
2
3
4
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
8
8
5
6
7
5
6
7
NIGHT ENHANCER  
NIGHT ENHANCER  
9
0
+
10  
ENT  
9
0
+
10  
ENT  
*2  
REC  
REC  
DISC SKIP  
DISC SKIP  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
Notes  
Notes  
*1 These buttons always control this unit regardless of the  
operation mode selector position.  
*1 These buttons always control your TV regardless of the  
operation mode selector position.  
*2 These buttons control this unit only when the component  
operation mode selector is set to AMP.  
Remote control  
Digital TV/Cable TV  
TV POWER  
Turns on or off the power.  
Increases or decreases the volume  
level.  
TV VOL +/–  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
Mutes the audio output.  
Changes the input source.  
*2 These buttons control your TV only when the operation mode  
selector is set to TV. For details, see the “TV” column on  
page 101.  
100 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Controlling other components  
PRESET/CH  
8
9
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
AUDIO  
MENU  
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE to control  
other components selected with the input selector buttons  
or . You must set the appropriate remote control code for  
each input source in advance (see page 102). The  
following table shows the function of each control button  
used to control other components assigned to each input  
selector button or . Be advised that some buttons may  
not correctly operate the selected component.  
3
4
5
SRCH MODE  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
1
2
ENTER  
XM  
PHONO  
V-AUX/DOCK  
DTV  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
0
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
TUNER  
XM MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
CBL/SAT  
MD/TAPE  
DVR/VCR 2  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
VCR  
1
DVD  
8
5
6
7
6
7
NIGHT ENHANCER  
9
0
+
10  
ENT  
A
SELECT  
REC  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
DISC SKIP  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
y
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
The remote control has 14 modes (input areas) to control  
components so that the remote control can operate up to 14  
different components.  
DVD player/  
DVD  
recorder  
Cable TV/  
Satellite  
tuner  
MD recorder/  
CD recorder  
VCR  
TV  
LD player  
CD player  
Tape deck  
Tuner  
iPod  
VCR power  
*2  
1
2
AV POWER  
CH +  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
TV channel  
up*3  
TV channel  
up*3  
TV channel  
up*3  
TV channel  
up*3  
TV channel  
up*3  
TV channel  
up*3  
TV channel  
up*3  
Channel up  
Channel up  
Channel up  
TV channel  
down*3  
TV channel  
down*3  
TV channel  
down*3  
TV channel  
down*3  
TV channel  
down*3  
TV channel  
down*3  
TV channel  
down*3  
CH –  
Channel down Channel down Channel down  
Title  
Title  
Title  
Title  
Band  
3
4
TITLE  
Subsequent  
menu  
ENTER  
Menu enter  
Menu select  
Menu select  
Preset up (1 to  
8)  
PRESET/CH k Menu up  
Menu up  
Menu up  
Up  
Preset down  
(1 to 8)  
PRESET/CH n Menu down  
Menu down  
Menu left  
Menu down  
Menu left  
Down  
Preset down  
(A to E)  
Previous  
menu  
A-E/CAT. l  
A-E/CAT. h  
Menu left  
Preset up (A Subsequent  
to E)  
Menu right  
Return  
Menu right  
Return  
Menu right  
Return  
Direction A/B  
menu  
Return  
5
RETURN  
1-9, 0, +10  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
Numeric  
buttons  
6
VCR search  
backward  
VCR search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward  
Search  
backward*4  
7 ll  
*2  
*2  
VCR search  
forward  
VCR search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward  
Search  
forward*4  
hh  
b
a
*2  
*2  
Skip  
backward  
Chapter/Skip Skip  
backward  
Skip  
backward  
Direction  
back  
Skip  
backward  
backward  
Chapter/Skip  
forward  
Direction  
forward  
Skip forward  
Skip forward Skip forward  
Skip forward  
Disc skip (player)  
Rec (recorder)  
REC/ DISC  
*2  
*2  
Rec  
Disc skip  
Stop  
Rec  
Rec  
VCR rec  
VCR rec  
SKIP  
*2  
*2  
s
Stop  
Stop  
Pause  
Stop  
Stop  
Pause  
Stop  
Pause  
Stop  
VCR stop  
VCR stop  
Pause  
(Play/Pause)*5  
*2  
*2  
Pause  
e
Pause  
Pause  
VCR pause  
VCR pause  
Play  
(Play/Pause)*5  
*2  
*2  
p
Play  
Play  
Play  
Play  
Play  
Play  
VCR play  
Menu  
VCR play  
Menu  
Previous  
menu  
8
MENU  
Menu  
Audio  
Audio  
9
0
A
AUDIO  
DISPLAY  
ENT  
Display  
Display  
Display  
Enter  
Display  
Display  
Display  
Display  
Enter  
Enter/recall  
Notes  
*1 This button is operational only when the original remote control supplied with the component has a POWER button.  
*2 These buttons operate your VCR only when you set the appropriate remote control code for VCR 1 (see page 102).  
*3 These buttons control your TV only when the operation mode selector is set to TV. For details, see the “TV” column on page 101.  
*4 Press and hold to search backward or forward.  
*5 Simple remote mode (see page 72).  
101 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Selecting a component to be controlled  
You can select a component to be controlled  
independently of the input source selected with the input  
selector buttons.  
Setting remote control codes  
You can control other components by setting the  
appropriate remote control codes. Codes can be set up for  
each input area. For a complete list of available remote  
control codes, refer to “LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL  
CODES” at the end of this manual.  
Press SELECT k/ nrepeatedly to select the  
desired component.  
The name of the component to be controlled appears in the  
display window on the remote control.  
The following table shows the default component  
(Library: component category) and the remote control  
code for each input area.  
SELECT  
Remote control code default settings  
Library  
Default  
Input area  
(component  
category)  
Manufacturer  
code  
Controlling optional components  
(Option mode)  
XM  
TUNER  
TUNER  
TV  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2604  
2607  
“OPTN” is an optional component control area that can be  
programmed with remote control functions independently  
from any input source. This area is useful for  
programming commands that are to be used only as a part  
of a macro function or for components that do not have a  
valid remote control code.  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
TUNER  
CD  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2602  
2300  
MULTI CH  
INPUT  
DVD  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2100  
2606  
To select the option mode, press SELECT n  
repeatedly until “OPTN” appears in the display  
window on the remote control.  
V-AUX/  
DOCK  
TUNER  
CBL/SAT  
MD/TAPE  
CD-R  
CABLE  
MD  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2500  
2400  
SELECT  
CD-R  
TV  
DTV  
VCR 1  
VCR  
DVR  
DVD  
Note  
DVR/VCR2  
DVD  
YAMAHA  
YAMAHA  
2807  
2100  
You cannot set a remote control code for the optional area. See  
page 104 to program buttons operated within this component  
control area.  
Note  
You may not be able to operate your YAMAHA component even  
if a YAMAHA remote control code is preset as listed above. In  
this case, try setting another YAMAHA remote control code.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE  
and then press an input selector button or  
to select the input area you want to set up.  
XM  
AMP  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
SOURCE  
TV  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
102 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
2
Press and hold LEARN for about 3 seconds  
using a ballpoint pen or similar object.  
The library name (ex. L;DVD) and the name of the  
selected input area (ex. DVD) appear alternately in  
the display window on the remote control.  
4
Press the numeric buttons to enter the four-  
digit remote control code for the component  
you want to use.  
For a complete list of available remote control codes,  
refer to “LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL CODES” at  
the end of this manual.  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
LEARN  
STERE
SELECT XTD SUR.  
SUR. DECOD
8
5
6
7
9
0
y
You can set a remote control code of a different type of  
component to an input area. Press l/ hrepeatedly to  
change the library (component category).  
Library choices: L;DVD, L;DVR, L;LD, L;CD, L;CDR,  
L;MD, L;TAP (tape), L;TUN (tuner),  
L;AMP, L;TV, L;CAB (cable), L;SAT  
(satellite), L;VCR  
• If you want to setup for another input area, press the input  
selector button or , or press SELECT k/ nrepeatedly to  
select the input area.  
5
Press ENTER to set the number.  
“OK” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if setting was successful.  
“NG” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if the setting was unsuccessful. In this case,  
start over from step 3.  
y
If you continuously want to set up another code for another  
component, press the input selector button or , or  
SELECT k/ nrepeatedly to select the component, then  
repeat steps 2 through 5.  
Notes  
• Be sure to press and hold LEARN for at least 3 seconds,  
otherwise the learning process will start.  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the setting mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 2.  
6
7
Press LEARN again to exit from the setup  
mode.  
LEARN  
3
Press ENTER.  
The four-digit code set for the selected component  
appears in the display window.  
Press por AV POWER to confirm whether  
you can control your component using the  
remote control.  
Note  
0000 appears in the display window if no code has been set.  
POWER  
or  
AV  
y
If operation is not possible and the manufacturer of your  
component has more than one code, try each of them until  
you find the correct one.  
Notes  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window on the remote control  
if you press a button not indicated in the respective step, or  
when you press more than one button simultaneously.  
• The supplied remote control does not contain all possible codes  
for commercially available audio and video components  
(including YAMAHA components). If operation is not possible  
with any of the remote control codes, program the new remote  
control function using the learn feature (see “Programming  
codes from other remote controls” on page 104) or use the  
remote control supplied with the component.  
• Functions programmed using the learn feature take priority over  
remote control code functions.  
103 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Programming codes from other  
remote controls  
You can program remote control codes from other remote  
controls. Use the learn feature if you want to program  
functions not included in the basic operations covered by  
the remote control codes, or an appropriate remote control  
code is not available. You can program the function of  
other remote control to the buttons in the highlighted areas  
in the following illustration. The buttons can be  
2
Place this remote control about 5 to 10 cm  
(2 to 4 in) apart from the other remote control  
on a flat surface so that their infrared  
transmitters are aimed at each other.  
programmed independently for each input area.  
Other remote control  
5 to 10 cm (2 to 4 in)  
PRESET/CH  
LEVEL  
TITLE  
SET MENU  
PURE DIRECT  
MENU  
SRCH MODE  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
ENTER  
AUDIO  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
A-E/CAT.  
PARAMETER STRAIGHT  
RETURN  
DISPLAY  
EFFECT  
PHONO  
TUNER  
XM MEMORY  
CLASSICAL LIVE/CLUB ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
1
2
3
4
STEREO  
SUR. DECODE  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
3
Press LEARN using a ballpoint pen or similar  
object.  
8
5
6
7
NIGHT ENHANCER  
9
0
+
10  
ENT  
SELECT  
“LEARN” and the name of the selected input area  
(ex. “DVD”) appear alternately in the display window  
on the remote control.  
REC  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
+
VOLUME  
DISC SKIP  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
TV MUTE  
TV INPUT  
MUTE  
Note  
LEARN  
The remote control transmits infrared rays. If the other remote  
control also uses infrared rays, this remote control can learn most  
of its functions. However, you may not be able to program some  
special signals or extremely long transmissions. Refer to the  
operating instructions for the other remote control.  
Notes  
• Do not press and hold LEARN. If you hold it down for  
more than 3 seconds, the remote enters the remote control  
code setting mode.  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the learning mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 3.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to SOURCE  
and then press an input selector button or  
to select an input area.  
XM  
AMP  
4
Press the button for which you want to  
program the new function.  
“LEARN” appears in the display window on the  
remote control.  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
SOURCE  
TV  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
Note  
Make sure that the operation mode selector is set to SOURCE.  
When you set the operation mode selector to AMP and program a  
remote control codes from other remote controls, the  
programmed key cannot operate the amplifier function of this  
unit.  
104 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Changing source names in the  
5
Press and hold the button you want to  
program on the other remote control until  
“OK” appears in the display window on the  
remote control.  
“NG” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if learning was unsuccessful. In this case, start  
over from step 4.  
display window  
You can change the name of the input source that appears  
in the display window on the remote control if you want to  
use a different name than the factory preset. This feature is  
useful when you have set an input area to control a  
different component.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press an input selector  
button or to select the input area you want  
to rename.  
Other remote control  
The name of the selected input area appears in the  
display window.  
AMP  
XM  
SOURCE  
TV  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
y
• If you want to program another function, repeat steps 4  
and 5.  
or  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
AMP  
• If you continuously want to program another function for  
another component, press SELECT k/ nto select the  
component, and then repeat steps 4 and 5.  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
SOURCE  
TV  
6
Press LEARN again to exit the learning  
mode.  
LEARN  
Notes  
2
Press RENAME using a ballpoint pen or  
similar object.  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window on the remote control  
if you press a button not indicated in the respective step, or  
when you press more than one button simultaneously.  
• This remote control can learn approximately 200 functions.  
However, depending on the signals learned, “FULL” may  
appear in the display before you program 200 functions. In this  
case, clear unnecessary programmed functions to make room  
for further learning.  
RENAME  
Note  
If you do not complete each of the following steps within 30  
seconds, the renaming mode will be automatically canceled.  
In this case, start over from 2.  
• Learning may not be possible in the following cases:  
– when the batteries in the remote control for this unit or other  
components are weak.  
– when the distance between the two remote controls is too  
great or too small.  
– when the remote control infrared windows are not facing each  
other at the appropriate angle.  
– when the remote control is exposed to direct sunlight.  
– when the function to be programmed is continuous or  
uncommon.  
105 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Macro programming features  
3
Press k/ nto select and enter a character.  
Pressing nchanges the character as follows:  
A to Z, 1 to 9, 0, + (plus), – (hyphen), ; (semicolon), /  
(slash), and space.  
The macro programming feature makes it possible to  
perform a series of operations with the press of a single  
button. For example, when you want to play a CD,  
normally you would turn on the components, select the  
CD input, and press the play button to start playback. The  
macro programming feature lets you perform all of these  
operations simply by pressing the CD macro button. The  
buttons listed as macro buttons below are factory set with  
macro programs. You can also program your own macros  
(see page 108).  
Pressing kchanges the characters in reverse order.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
MACRO operations  
Macro buttons  
4
Press hto move the cursor to the next  
position.  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
PRESET/CH  
REC  
XM  
AUDIO SEL  
CD  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DISC SKIP  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
RENAME  
PHONO  
TUNER  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
ENTER  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
A-E/CAT.  
MACRO  
MACRO ON/OFF  
y
1
Set the MACRO ON/OFF selector to ON.  
Press lto move the cursor to the previous position.  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
5
Press ENTER to set the new name.  
“OK” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if renaming was successful.  
“NG” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if renaming was unsuccessful. In this case,  
start over from step 3.  
2
3
Press the desired macro button.  
y
If you continuously want to rename another input area, press  
the input selector button or , or press SELECT k/ n  
repeatedly to select the component, then repeat steps 3  
through 5.  
Set the MACRO ON/OFF selector to OFF  
when you finish to using the macro  
programming operation.  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
6
Press RENAME again to exit the renaming  
mode.  
RENAME  
Notes  
Note  
• While the remote control is running a macro program, it does  
not accept any other operation until it has completed running  
the program (the transmission indicator stops flashing).  
• Continue to aim the remote control at the component the macro  
is operating until the macro operation is complete.  
“ERROR” appears in the display window on the remote control if  
you press a button not indicated in the respective step, or when  
you press more than one button simultaneously.  
y
This feature is useful when you change the input or output  
assignment for digital jacks and component video input jacks.  
Refer to “INPUT RENAME” on page 94.  
106 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Default macro functions  
Pressing macro  
button  
To automatically transmit these signals in order  
First  
Second  
Third  
STANDBY  
POWER  
XM  
STANDBY  
POWER  
POWER  
POWER  
POWER  
(*1)  
(*2)  
TV  
XM  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
(*3)  
(CD area) (*4)  
MULTI CH IN  
MULTI CH IN  
-
-
V AUX/DOCK  
V AUX/DOCK  
CBL/SAT  
MD/TAPE  
CD-R  
CBL/SAT  
MD/TAPE  
CD-R  
POWER  
(*1)  
(MD/TAPE area) (*4)  
(CD-R area) (*4)  
DTV  
DTV  
VCR 1  
VCR 1  
(VCR 1 area) (*4)  
(DVR/VCR 2 area) (*4)  
(DVD area) (*4)  
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
*1 You can turn on some components (including YAMAHA components) connected to this unit by connecting them to the AC  
OUTLETS on the rear panel of this unit. Power control may not be synchronized with this unit depending on the component. For  
details, refer to the operating instructions for the connected component.  
*2 When the remote control code for your TV is set up for either DTV or PHONO (see page 102), you can turn on the power of your TV  
without selecting an input source. The remote control code set up for DTV takes priority over the one for PHONO.  
*3 When TUNER is selected as the input source, this unit plays the last station received before the unit was set in the standby mode.  
*4 Playback can be started for any YAMAHA remote control-compatible MD recorder, CD player, CD recorder, DVD player, or DVD  
recorder. When using macros to operate other components, you will need to program the play button on the input area of that  
component (see page 104) or set a remote control code (see page 102).  
107 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Programming macro operations  
You can program your own macro and use the macro  
programming feature to transmit several remote control  
commands in sequence at the press of a button. Be sure to  
set up remote control codes or perform learning operations  
before programming the macro.  
Note  
“AGAIN” appears in the display window if you press a  
button other than a macro button.  
3
Press the buttons for the functions you want  
to include in the macro operation in  
sequence.  
Notes  
You can set up to 10 steps (10 functions). After you  
have set 10 steps, “FULL” appears and the remote  
control automatically exits the macro mode. The  
following example is for programming the following  
procedure:  
Step 1 (“MCR 1”): Press DVD.  
Step 2 (“MCR 2”): Press AV POWER.  
Step 3 (“MCR 3”): Press SLEEP.  
• The default macro is not cleared when a new macro is  
programmed for a button. The default macro can be used again  
when the programmed macro is cleared.  
• It is not possible to add a new signal (macro step) to the default  
macro. Programming a macro changes all macro contents.  
• We do not recommend programming continuous operations  
such as volume control in a macro.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press MACRO using a  
ballpoint pen or similar object.  
“MCR ?” appears in the display window on the  
remote control.  
MCR 2: AV POWER  
POWER  
TV  
POWER  
AV  
STANDBY  
POWER  
XM  
SEL  
SLEEP  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
2
MCR 3: SLEEP  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
3
1
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
DVD  
MCR 1: DVD  
MACRO  
or  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Indicates the  
number of macro  
steps entered  
Note  
Flashes alternately so you can  
set the next step  
If you do not complete each of the following steps within 30  
seconds, the macro programming mode will be  
automatically canceled. In this case, start over from step 1.  
Note  
2
Press the macro button you want to use to  
operate the macro.  
To change the selected input area, press SELECT k/ n.  
Pressing the input selector buttons will program a macro step,  
whereas SELECT k/ nonly changes the selected input area.  
The macro button name (ex. “M;DVD”) and the  
selected component name (ex. “DVD”) appear  
alternately in the display window on the remote  
control.  
4
Press MACRO again using a ballpoint pen or  
similar object when the operation sequence  
you want to program is complete.  
STANDBY  
POWER  
XM  
Note  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
“ERROR” appears in the display window if you press more  
than one button simultaneously.  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
108 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Clearing configurations  
You can clear all changes made in each function set, such  
as learned functions, macros, renamed input area names  
and setup remote control ID.  
3
Press and hold CLEAR again for about 3  
seconds.  
WAIT” appears in the display window. If clearing  
was successful, “C;OK” appears in the display  
window on the remote control.  
Clearing function sets  
CLEAR  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press CLEAR by using a  
ballpoint pen or similar object.  
“CLEAR” appears in the display window.  
y
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Once you have cleared a learned function for a button, the  
button reverts to the factory setting (or to the manufacturer  
setting, if you have set remote control codes).  
CLEAR  
Notes  
or  
• “L;ALL” and “FCTRY” may take about 30 seconds to  
complete.  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
• “C;NG” appears in the display window if clearing was  
unsuccessful. In this case start over from step 2.  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window if you press a  
button not indicated in the respective step, or if you press  
more than one button simultaneously.  
Note  
If you do not complete each of the following steps within 30  
seconds, the clearing mode will be automatically canceled.  
In this case, start over from step 1.  
2
Press k/ nto select the clear mode.  
L;CD (etc.) (L; Name of an input area)  
Clears all learned functions in the respective  
input area. The name of a component is shown  
after a semicolon (;). Press an input selector  
button to select the input area.  
L;AMP  
Clears all learned functions for controlling the  
amplifier functions of this unit.  
Clears all learned functions.  
L;ALL  
M;ALL  
Clears all programmed macros.  
RNAME Clears all renamed source names.  
FCTRY  
Clears all remote functions and returns the  
remote to the factory settings.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
109 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Clearing a learned function  
You can clear the function learned for a certain button in  
each control area.  
3
Press and hold CLEAR using a ballpoint pen  
or similar object and then press the button  
you want to clear for about 3 seconds.  
“C;OK” appears in the display window if clearing  
was successful. Once “C;OK” appears in the display  
window on the remote control, release the ballpoint  
pen or similar object used to press CLEAR to exit the  
clearing mode. The remote control returns to the  
learning mode.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press an input selector  
button or to select the input area  
containing the function you want to clear.  
The selected component name appears in the display  
window.  
AMP  
XM  
SOURCE  
TV  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
or  
LEARN CLEAR  
-
ME  
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
y
• If you continuously want to clear another function, repeat  
step 4.  
• If you continuously want to clear another function for  
another component, press SELECT k/ nto select the  
input area, then repeat step 4.  
• Once you clear a learned function, the button reverts to the  
factory setting (or to the manufacturer setting if you have  
set remote control codes).  
2
Press LEARN using a ballpoint pen or similar  
object.  
“LEARN” and the selected component name (ex.  
“DVD”) appear alternately in the display window.  
4
Press LEARN again to exit.  
Notes  
• “C;NG” appears in the display window on the remote control if  
clearing was unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 2.  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window if you press more than  
one button simultaneously.  
LEARN  
Notes  
• Do not press and hold LEARN. If you hold it down for  
more than 3 seconds, the remote control enters the remote  
control code setting mode.  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the learning mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 2.  
110 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE CONTROL FEATURES  
Clearing a macro function  
You can clear the function programmed for a certain  
macro button.  
2
Press and hold CLEAR using a ballpoint pen  
or similar object, then press the macro  
button you want to clear for about 3 seconds.  
“C;OK” appears in the display window on the remote  
control if clearing was successful.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press MACRO using a  
ballpoint pen or similar object.  
“MCR ?” appears in the display window on the  
remote control.  
-
V AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
CD-R  
DVD  
DTV  
VCR 1 DVR/VCR 2  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
OFF ON  
MACRO LEARN CLEAR  
AME  
MACRO  
or  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
y
• If you continuously want to clear another function, repeat  
step 2.  
• Once you clear a programmed function, the button reverts  
to the factory setting (or to the manufacturer setting if you  
have set remote control codes).  
Note  
If you do not complete each of the following steps within 30  
seconds, the macro programming mode will be  
automatically canceled. In this case, start over from step 1.  
3
Press MACRO again to exit the macro  
programming mode.  
Notes  
• “C;NG” appears in the display window on the remote control if  
clearing was unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 2.  
• “ERROR” appears in the display window on the remote control  
if you press more than one button simultaneously.  
111 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
This unit allows you to configure a multi-room audio system. The multi-zone configuration feature enables you to set this  
unit to reproduce separate input sources in the main room and second room (Zone 2). You can control this unit from the  
second room using the supplied remote control.  
Only analog signals are sent to the second and third rooms. Any source you want to listen to in the second or third  
room must be connected using the analog (AUDIO L/R) input jacks on this unit.  
Connecting the Zone 2 components  
You need the following additional equipment to use the multi-room functions of this unit:  
An infrared signal receiver in the second room.  
An infrared emitter in the main room. This emitter transmits the infrared signals from the remote control in the second  
room to the main room (to a CD player or DVD player, for example).  
An amplifier and speakers for the second room.  
y
You do not need an extra amplifier and speakers for the second room if you want to use the internal amplifiers of this unit.  
• Since there are many possible ways to connect and use this unit in a multi-room configuration, we recommend that you consult with  
your nearest authorized YAMAHA dealer or service center for the Zone 2 connections that best meet your requirements.  
REMOTE  
IN  
REMOTE  
IN  
REMOTE  
IN  
OUT  
REMOTE  
OUT  
OUT  
Infrared signal  
receiver  
YAMAHA  
component  
YAMAHA  
component  
This unit  
Using external amplifiers  
To use an external amplifier in Zone 2, connect the external amplifier to ZONE OUT terminals and select “EXT” in  
“ZONE2 AMP” (see page 99).  
ZONE 2 AUDIO OUT  
SP OUT  
Amplifier  
MONITOR OUT  
DVD player  
This unit  
Remote control  
(or other component)  
MAIN  
SYSTEM ZONE 2  
VIDEO IN  
AUDIO IN  
Infrared signal  
receiver  
Infrared emitter  
Second room  
(Zone 2)  
Main room  
(Main zone)  
REMOTE OUT  
REMOTE IN  
Notes  
• Adjust the Zone 2 volume by using the amplifier in the second/third room when “ZONE2 VOL” is set to “FIX” (see page 99).  
• To avoid unexpected noise, DO NOT use the Zone 2 feature with CDs encoded in DTS.  
112 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
Using the internal amplifiers of this unit  
IMPORTANT SAFETY NOTICE  
The SP1 speaker terminals of this Receiver should not be connected to a Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or more  
than one loudspeaker per channel.  
Connection to a Passive Loudspeaker Selector Box or multiple speakers per channel could create an abnormally low  
impedance load resulting in amplifier damage. See this owner’s manual for correct usage.  
Compliance with minimum speaker impedance information for all channels must be maintained at all times. This  
information is found on the back panel of your Receiver.  
Connect the Zone 2 speakers directly to the SP1 speaker terminals and select “[SP1]” for “ZONE2 AMP” (see page 99).  
SP1  
+
+
PRESENCE  
+
+
R
R
L
L
SURROUND BACK/  
BI-AMP  
SINGLE  
Second room  
(Zone 2)  
This unit  
Controlling Zone 2  
You can select Zone 2 by using the control buttons on the  
front panel or on the remote control.  
2
Press ZONE 2 CONTROLS on the front panel  
to activate the Zone 2 control mode.  
While this unit is in the Zone 2 control mode, the  
ZONE2 indicator flashes.  
Selecting Zone 2  
ZONE 2  
CONTROLS  
ZONE2  
Flashes  
Front panel operations  
1
Press ZONE 2 ON/OFF on the front panel to  
individually turn on or off Zone 2.  
In the Zone 2 control mode, you can perform the  
following operation in Zone 2.  
• Adjusting the tonality of Zone 2  
ZONE 2  
• Adjusting the balance of the speaker level in Zone 2  
• AM, FM or XM Satellite Radio tuning in Zone 2  
ON/OFF  
y
y
• This unit automatically exits the Zone 2 control mode after  
approximately 5 seconds from the last operation is  
performed.  
• See page 115 for details about the Zone 2 input select  
mode.  
Once MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel is pressed  
inward to the ON position, you can also press POWER and  
STANDBY on the remote control to turn on the main zone  
and Zone 2.  
• See page 115 for details about the Zone 2 volume control  
mode.  
113 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
Turning on or off Zone 2 using the  
remote control  
POWER and STANDBY on the remote control work  
differently depending on the selected zone that appears in  
the display window on the remote control.  
3
Refer to “Selecting the input source of Zone  
2”, “Adjusting the volume level of Zone 2”,  
“Adjusting the balance of the speaker level in  
Zone 2” or “Adjusting the tonal quality of  
Zone 2” on page 116 to perform further  
operations.  
When the main zone or Zone 2 mode is selected, you  
can turn on the main zone or Zone 2 or set them to the  
standby mode individually.  
When the all mode is selected, pressing POWER turns  
on the main zone or Zone 2 simultaneously and  
pressing STANDBY sets them to the standby mode  
simultaneously.  
Remote control operations  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SELECT krepeatedly to select  
“ZONE 2”.  
POWER  
Control mode  
Display window  
and  
“ZONE 2” is displayed in the display window on the  
remote control.  
STANDBY  
Turns on the main  
zone only or sets it to  
the standby mode.  
Main zone  
mode  
Name of the selected  
input area  
AMP  
“ZONE 2” or “2;name Turns on Zone 2 or  
SOURCE  
SELECT  
Zone 2 mode of the selected input  
sets it to the standby  
mode.  
TV  
area”  
POWER: turns on  
the main zone and  
Zone 2.  
All mode  
“ALL”  
STANDBY: sets the  
main zone and Zone  
2 to the standby  
mode.  
Notes  
2
3
Refer to “Selecting the input source of Zone  
2”, “Adjusting the volume level of Zone 2”,  
“Adjusting the balance of the speaker level in  
Zone 2” or “Adjusting the tonal quality of  
Zone 2” on page 116 to perform further  
operations.  
• When the remote control is in the main zone mode, “MAIN”  
appears for a few seconds when POWER or STANDBY is  
pressed.  
• “ALL” appears in the display window on the remote control  
only when SELECT nis pressed.  
Press SELECT k/ nto exit from the Zone 2  
mode.  
114 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
Selecting the input source of Zone 2  
Adjusting the volume level of Zone 2  
Press ZONE 2 INPUT to activate the Zone 2 input  
select mode and then rotate the INPUT selector  
on the front panel (or set the operation mode  
selector to AMP and then press one of the input  
selector buttons on the remote control) to select  
the input source of the selected zone.  
Press ZONE 2 VOLUME to activate the Zone 2  
volume control mode and then rotate VOLUME  
on the front panel (or set the control mode of the  
remote control to “ZONE 2” (see page 114) and  
then press VOLUME +/–) to adjust the volume  
level of the selected zone.  
If the remote control is used to select the input source, “2:  
name of the selected input source” is displayed in the  
display window on the remote control when Zone 2 is  
selected respectively.  
ZONE 2 VOLUME  
INPUT  
ZONE 2  
INPUT  
or  
VOLUME  
+
VOLUME  
or  
XM  
AMP  
PHONO  
TUNER  
CD  
MULTI CH IN  
CD-R  
DVD  
Front panel  
Remote control  
SOURCE  
TV  
-
V
AUX/DOCK CBL/SAT MD/TAPE  
DTV  
VCR  
1
DVR/VCR 2  
y
Press MUTE on the remote control to mute the sound output to  
the selected zone.  
Select TUNER as the input source to use the TUNER  
features in the selected zone. For details about the  
TUNER operations, see “FM/AM TUNING” on  
page 53.  
Select XM as the input source to use the XM Satellite  
Radio features in the selected zone. For details about  
the XM Satellite Radio operations, see “XM  
SATELLITE RADIO TUNING” on page 60.  
Note  
When you use the external amplifiers in Zone 2, VOLUME +/–  
can be used only when “ZONE2 VOL” is set to “VAR” in “ZONE  
SET” (see page 99).  
Note  
The selected input source is shared across all zones.  
y
You must complete this step within 5 seconds while the selected  
zone flashes in the front panel display. Otherwise, the currently  
selected zone mode is automatically canceled. In this case, press  
ZONE 2 INPUT on the front panel again.  
115 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USING MULTI-ZONE CONFIGURATION  
Adjusting the balance of the speaker  
Adjusting the tonal quality of Zone 2  
level in Zone 2  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press SELECT krepeatedly to select  
“ZONE 2”.  
1
2
Press ZONE 2 CONTROLS on the front panel  
to activate the Zone 2 control mode.  
“ZONE 2” is displayed in the display window on the  
remote control.  
ZONE 2  
CONTROLS  
AMP  
SOURCE  
SELECT  
Press TONE CONTROL repeatedly to select  
“BALANCE” and then rotate PROGRAM on  
the front panel to adjust the balance of the  
front left and right speaker level of the  
selected zone.  
TV  
PROGRAM  
TONE CONTROL  
2
Set the operation mode selector to AMP and  
then press CH +/– on the remote control to  
adjust the high-frequency response  
(TREBLE) or TV VOL +/– to adjust the  
low-frequency response (BASS) respectively.  
+
TV VOL  
+
CH  
TREBLE  
BASS  
y
You can also adjust the tonal quality of Zone 2 by using TONE  
CONTROL on the front panel. For details, see “Adjusting the  
tonal quality” on page 49.  
Note  
Check that “ZONE 2” is displayed in the display window of the  
remote control before you adjust the tonal quality of the  
corresponding zone (see page 114).  
116 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SETUP  
ADVANCED SETUP  
This unit has additional menus that are displayed in the front panel display. The advanced setup menu offers additional  
operations to adjust and customize the way this unit operates. Change the initial settings (indicated in bold under each  
parameter) to reflect the needs of your listening environment.  
Notes  
• The settings you make are reflected next time you press MASTER ON/OFF inward to the ON position to turn on this unit (see  
page 30).  
• Only MASTER ON/OFF, STRAIGHT and the PROGRAM selector are effective while you are using the advanced setup menu.  
• All the other operations cannot be made while you are using the advanced setup menu.  
• The advanced setup menu is only available in the front panel display.  
Using ADVANCED SETUP  
3
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front  
panel to select the parameter you want to  
adjust.  
The name of the selected parameter appears in the  
front panel display.  
VOLUME  
See page 118 for a complete list of available  
parameters.  
MAIN ZONE  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
ON/OFF  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
PROGRAM  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
2,4 3  
1-2,5  
Currently selected  
parameter  
Currently selected  
parameter setting  
1
2
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to turn  
off this unit.  
SPEAKER IMP.  
MIN  
8
MASTER  
4
5
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel  
repeatedly to change the selected parameter  
setting.  
Press and hold STRAIGHT on the front panel  
and then press MASTER ON/OFF inward to  
the ON position to turn on this unit.  
This unit turns on, and the advanced setup menu  
appears in the front panel display.  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
While holding  
STRAIGHT  
down  
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to save  
the new setting and turn off this unit.  
EFFECT  
MASTER  
MASTER  
y
The settings you made are reflected next time you turn on  
this unit.  
117 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SETUP  
Speaker impedance SPEAKER IMP.  
Use this feature to set the speaker impedance of this unit  
so that it matches that of your speakers.  
Wake on RS-232C access WAKE ON  
RS232C  
Use this feature to set this unit to transmit data via the RS-  
232C interface when this unit is in the standby mode.  
Choices: YES, NO  
Choices: 8MIN, 6MIN  
Select “8ΩMIN” to set the speaker impedance to 8 .  
Select “6MIN” to set the speaker impedance to 6 .  
Initial setting:  
[U.S.A. and Canada models]: YES  
[Other models]: NO  
SPEAKER  
Speaker  
Impedance level  
Select “YES” to set this unit to transmit data via the  
RS-232C interface.  
IMP.  
The impedance of each  
speaker must be 8 or  
higher.  
Select “NO” to set this unit not to transmit data via the  
RS-232C interface.  
Front  
Remote control AMP ID RC AMP ID  
Use this feature to set the AMP ID of this unit for remote  
control recognition (see page 103).  
Center  
Surround  
8ΩMIN  
The impedance of each  
speaker must be 8 or  
higher.  
Choices: ID1, ID2  
Select “ID1” when the remote control AMP ID library  
code is set to “2001”.  
Select “ID2” when the remote control AMP ID library  
code is set to “2002”.  
Surround back  
The impedance of each  
speaker must be 4 or  
higher.  
Front  
Note  
Center  
Surround  
6ΩMIN  
The impedance of each  
speaker must be 6 or  
higher.  
You need to set the corresponding remote control AMP library  
code for the remote control (see page 103).  
Surround back  
Remote control TUNER ID RC TUNER ID  
Use this feature to set the TUNER ID of this unit for  
remote control recognition (see page 121).  
Choices: ID1, ID2  
User presets USER PRESET  
Use this feature to reset all the parameters of this unit to  
the initial factory settings (see page 130).  
Choices: CANCEL, RESET  
Select “ID1” when the remote control TUNER ID  
library code is set to “2602”.  
Select “CANCEL” not to reset any parameters of this  
unit.  
Select “ID2” when the remote control TUNER ID  
library code is set to “2603”.  
Select “RESET” to reset the parameters of this unit.  
Note  
Notes  
You need to set the corresponding remote control TUNER library  
code for the remote control (see page 121).  
• This setting completely resets all the parameters of this unit  
including the “SET MENU” parameters. However, the  
advanced setup menu parameters will not be initialized.  
• The initial factory settings are activated next time you turn on  
this unit.  
Remote control XM ID RC XM ID  
Use this feature to set the XM ID of this unit for remote  
control recognition (see page 121).  
Choices: ID1, ID2  
Remote sensor REMOTE SENSOR  
Use this feature to activate or deactivate the signal-  
receiving capability of the remote control sensor on the  
front panel of this unit.  
Select “ID1” when the remote control XM ID library  
code is set to “2604”.  
Select “ID2” when the remote control XM ID library  
code is set to “2605”.  
Choices: ON, OFF  
Select “ON” if you want to activate the signal-  
receiving capability of the remote control sensor.  
Select “OFF” if you want to deactivate the signal-  
receiving capability of the remote control sensor.  
Note  
You need to set the corresponding remote control XM library  
code for the remote control (see page 121).  
Note  
We recommend setting the parameter to “ON” in most cases.  
118 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SETUP  
Bi-AMP BI-AMP  
Setting remote control ID  
Use to activate or deactivate the bi-AMP function.  
Choices: ON, OFF  
When using multiple YAMAHA receivers/amplifiers, you  
may be able to operate the other components  
simultaneously with the default code setting. In this case,  
set one of the alternative codes to operate this unit  
separately.  
Select “ON” if you want to activate the bi-AMP  
function.  
Select “OFF” if you want to deactivate the bi-AMP  
function.  
Note  
Setting remote control AMP ID  
When BI-AMP is set to ON, the SURROUND BACK terminals  
cannot be used to connect surround back speakers in that the  
SURROUND BACK terminals are already used for the bi-AMP  
connection (see page 16).  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE.  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Video reset VIDEO RESET  
Use to initialize the parameter settings for “DISPLAY  
SET” in “OPTION MENU” (see page 96).  
Choices: YES, CANCEL  
or  
Note  
2
Press and hold LEARN for about 3 seconds  
using a ballpoint pen or similar object and  
then press l/ hrepeatedly until “L;AMP”  
appears in the display window on the remote  
The parameter setting for “DIMMER”, “SHORT MESSAGE”,  
“ON SCREEN” and “FL SCROLL” is not initialized (see  
page 96).  
control.  
PRESET/CH  
LEARN  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
Notes  
• Be sure to press and hold LEARN for at least 3 seconds,  
otherwise the learning process will start.  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the setting mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 1.  
3
Press ENTER.  
The four-digit code set for the selected input area  
appears in the display window on the remote control.  
PRESET/CH  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
119 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SETUP  
Setting remote control tuner ID or XM ID  
4
Press the numeric buttons to enter the four-  
digit remote control code for the input area  
you want to use.  
1
Set the operation mode selector to AMP or  
SOURCE and then press TUNER or XM on  
the remote control to select the tuner or XM  
to change the remote control ID.  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
STERE
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECOD
AMP  
8
5
6
7
TUNER  
SOURCE  
9
0
TV  
or  
or  
AMP  
SOURCE  
TV  
Remote control AMP codes  
Select one of the following codes to set the remote control  
AMP code for the input area you want to use.  
XM  
AMP library  
Remote  
code  
(remote control  
Function  
control AMP  
ID  
2
Press and hold LEARN for about 3 seconds  
using a ballpoint pen or similar object and  
then l/ hrepeatedly until “L;TUN” and  
“TUNER”, or “L;TUN” and “XM” alternately  
appear in the display window on the remote  
setting)  
2001  
To operate this unit using the  
ID1  
(initial setting) default code.  
(initial setting)  
To operate this unit using an  
alternative code.  
2002  
ID2  
control.  
PRESET/CH  
Note  
You need to set the corresponding remote control AMP ID  
(see page 118).  
LEARN  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
5
Press ENTER to set the number.  
“OK” appears in the display window if setting was  
successful.  
Notes  
“NG” appears in the display window if the setting  
was unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 1.  
• Be sure to press and hold LEARN for at least 3 seconds,  
otherwise the learning process will start.  
PRESET/CH  
• If you do not complete each of the following steps within  
30 seconds, the setting mode will be automatically  
canceled. In this case, start over from step 1.  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
3
Press ENTER.  
The four-digit code set for the selected input area  
appears in the display window on the remote control.  
6
Press LEARN again to exit from the setup  
mode.  
PRESET/CH  
LEARN  
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
120 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ADVANCED SETUP  
4
Press the numeric buttons to enter the four-  
digit remote control code for the input area  
you want to use.  
5
Press ENTER to set the number.  
“OK” appears in the display window if setting was  
successful.  
“NG” appears in the display window if the setting  
was unsuccessful. In this case, start over from step 1.  
LIVE/CLUB  
CLASSICAL  
1
ENTERTAIN MOVIE  
2
3
4
STEREO  
SELECT EXTD SUR.  
SUR. DECODE  
PRESET/CH  
8
5
6
7
9
0
ENTER  
A-E/CAT.  
Remote control tuner codes  
Select one of the following codes to set the remote control  
tuner code for the input area you want to use.  
6
Press LEARN again to exit from the setup  
mode.  
Tuner library  
Remote  
code  
(remote control  
Function  
control  
tuner ID  
LEARN  
setting)  
2602  
To operate this unit using the  
ID1  
(initial setting) default code.  
To operate this unit using an  
alternative code.  
(initial setting)  
2603  
ID2  
Remote control XM codes  
Select one of the following codes to set the remote control  
XM code for the input area you want to use.  
XM library  
Remote  
code  
(remote control  
Function  
control XM  
ID  
setting)  
2604  
To operate this unit using the  
ID1  
(initial setting) default code.  
(initial setting)  
To operate this unit using an  
alternative code.  
2605  
ID2  
Note  
You need to set the corresponding remote control tuner ID  
or XM ID (see page 118).  
121 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
Refer to the table below when this unit does not function properly. If the problem you are experiencing is not listed below  
or if the instruction below does not help, turn off this unit, disconnect the power cable, and contact the nearest authorized  
YAMAHA dealer or service center.  
General  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
This unit fails to turn  
on or enters the  
standby mode soon  
after the power is  
turned on.  
The power cable is not connected or the  
plug is not completely inserted.  
Connect the power cable firmly.  
The speaker impedance setting is  
incorrect.  
Set the speaker impedance to match your speakers.  
29  
13  
The protection circuitry has been  
activated.  
Make sure that all speaker wire connections on this  
unit and on all speakers are secure and that the wire  
for each connection does not touch anything other  
than its respective connection.  
This unit has been exposed to a strong  
external electric shock (such as lightning  
or strong static electricity).  
Set this unit to the standby mode, disconnect the  
power cable, plug it back in after 30 seconds and then  
use it normally.  
No sound.  
Incorrect input or output cable  
connections.  
Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists,  
the cables may be defective.  
20-26  
The optimizer microphone is connected.  
Disconnect the optimizer microphone.  
Set Audio input jack select to “AUTO”.  
35  
39  
Audio input jack select is set to “HDMI”,  
“COAX/OPT” or “ANALOG”.  
Audio input jack select is set to  
“ANALOG” while playing a source  
encoded in Dolby Digital or DTS.  
Set Audio input jack select to “AUTO” or  
“COAX/OPT”.  
39  
No appropriate input source has been  
selected.  
Select an appropriate input source with the INPUT  
selector on the front panel (or the input selector  
buttons on the remote control).  
37, 40  
Speaker connections are not secure.  
The volume is turned down.  
The sound is muted.  
Secure the connections.  
Turn up the volume.  
13  
40  
Press MUTE or VOLUME +/– on the remote control  
to resume audio output and then adjust the volume.  
Signals this unit cannot reproduce are  
being input from a source component,  
such as a CD-ROM.  
Play a source whose signals can be reproduced by this  
unit.  
18  
92  
The HDMI components connected to this  
unit do not support the HDCP copy  
protection standards.  
Connect HDMI components that support the HDCP  
copy protection standards.  
“SUPPORT AUDIO” is set to “OTHER”  
and “HDMI” audio signals are not being  
played back on this unit.  
Set “SUPPORT AUDIO” to “HTR-6090” in  
“MANUAL SETUP”.  
122 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
See  
page  
Problem  
No picture.  
Cause  
Remedy  
The output and input for the picture are  
connected to different types of video  
jacks.  
Set “V CONV.” to “ON” or connect your source  
components in the same way as you connect your  
video monitor to this unit.  
96  
Non-standard video signals are input.  
“SHORT MESSAGE” is set to “OFF”.  
“GRAY BACK” is set to “OFF”.  
“V CONV.” is set to “OFF”.  
Short message  
displays do not  
appears in the video  
monitor.  
Set “SHORT MESSAGE” to “ON”.  
Set “GRAY BACK” to “AUTO”.  
Set “V CONV.” to “ON”.  
97  
96  
96  
The signals input at the HDMI IN1 or  
HDMI IN2 jack are being output at the  
HDMI OUT jack.  
Video signals in the progressive format or  
HDTV video signals are input.  
The sound suddenly  
goes off.  
The protection circuitry has been activated Check that the speaker impedance setting is correct.  
29, 118  
because of a short circuit, etc.  
Check that the speaker wires are not touching each  
other and then turn this unit back on.  
The sleep timer has turned off this unit.  
The sound is muted.  
Turn on this unit, and play the source again.  
40  
Press MUTE or VOLUME +/– on the remote control  
to resume audio output.  
Sound is heard from  
the speaker on one  
side only.  
Incorrect cable connections.  
Connect the cables properly. If the problem persists,  
the cables may be defective.  
13  
89  
Incorrect settings in “SP LEVEL”.  
Adjust the “SP LEVEL” settings.  
Only the center  
speaker outputs  
substantial sound.  
When playing a monaural source with a  
CINEMA DSP program, the source signal  
is directed to the center channel, and the  
front and surround speakers output effect  
sounds.  
No sound is heard  
from the center  
speaker.  
“CENTER SP” in “SET MENU” is set to  
“NONE”.  
Set “CENTER SP” to “SML” or “LRG”.  
87  
44  
One of the HiFi DSP programs (except for Try another sound field program.  
“7ch Stereo”) has been selected.  
No sound from the  
presence speakers.  
The sound field programs are turned off.  
Press STRAIGHT to turn them on.  
Try another sound field program.  
48  
37  
You are using a source or program  
combination that does not output sound  
from all channels.  
No sound is heard  
from the surround  
speakers.  
“SUR. L/R SP” in “SET MENU” is set to Set “SUR. L/R SP” to “SML” or “LRG”.  
“NONE”.  
87  
48  
This unit is in the “STRAIGHT” mode  
and a monaural source is being played  
back.  
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel so that  
“STRAIGHT” disappears from the front panel  
display.  
No sound is heard  
from the surround  
back speakers.  
“SUR. L/R SP” in “SET MENU” is set to Set “SUR. L/R SP” and “SB L/R SP” to a setting  
87  
88  
“NONE” and “SB L/R SP” is  
automatically set to “NONE”.  
other than “NONE”.  
“SB L/R SP” in “SET MENU” is set to  
“NONE”.  
Set “SB L/R SP” to a setting other than “NONE”.  
123 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
No sound is heard  
from the subwoofer.  
“LFE/BASS OUT” in “SET MENU” is  
set to “FRONT” when a Dolby Digital or  
DTS signal is being played.  
Set “LFE/BASS OUT” to “SWFR” or “BOTH”.  
86  
“LFE/BASS OUT” in “SET MENU” is  
set to “SWFR” or “FRONT” when a 2-  
channel source is being played.  
Set “LFE/BASS OUT” to “BOTH”.  
86  
The source does not contain low-  
frequency signals.  
Dolby Digital or DTS  
sources cannot be  
played. (Dolby Digital  
or DTS indicator in  
the front panel  
The connected component is not set to  
output Dolby Digital or DTS digital  
signals.  
Make an appropriate setting following the operating  
instructions for your component.  
39  
Audio input jack select is set to  
“ANALOG”.  
Set Audio input jack select to “AUTO”.  
display does not light  
up.)  
A humming sound is  
heard.  
Incorrect cable connections.  
Connect the audio cables firmly. If the problem  
persists, the cables may be defective.  
23  
23  
No connection from the turntable to the  
GND terminal.  
Connect the grounding cable of your turntable to the  
GND terminal of this unit.  
The volume level is  
low while a record is  
being played.  
The record is being played on a turntable  
with an MC cartridge.  
Connect your turntable to this unit through an MC-  
head amplifier.  
The volume level  
cannot be increased,  
or the sound is  
distorted.  
The component connected to the AUDIO  
OUT (REC) jacks of this unit is turned  
off.  
Turn on the power of the component.  
The sound effect  
cannot be recorded.  
It is not possible to record the sound effect  
with a recording component.  
A source cannot be  
recorded by a digital  
recording component  
connected to the  
DIGITAL OUTPUT  
jack.  
The source component is not connected to Connect the source component to the DIGITAL  
21, 23  
the DIGITAL INPUT jacks of this unit.  
INPUT jacks.  
Some components cannot record Dolby  
Digital or DTS sources.  
A source cannot be  
recorded by an  
analog component  
connected to the  
AUDIO OUT (REC)  
jacks.  
The source component is not connected to Connect the source component to the analog AUDIO  
23  
the analog AUDIO IN jacks of this unit.  
IN jacks.  
The sound field  
“MEMORY GUARD” in “SET MENU”  
Set “MEMORY GUARD” to “OFF”.  
98  
parameters and some is set to “ON”.  
other settings of this  
unit cannot be  
changed.  
This unit does not  
operate properly.  
The internal microcomputer has been  
Disconnect the power cable from the AC wall outlet  
and then plug it in again after about 30 seconds.  
frozen by an external electric shock (such  
as lightning or excessive static electricity)  
or by a power supply with low voltage.  
124 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
Make sure all speaker cables are connected correctly.  
“CHECK SP WIRES”  
appears in the front  
panel display.  
Speaker cables are short-circuited.  
13  
There is noise  
interference from  
digital or radio  
This unit is too close to the digital or high- Move this unit further away from such equipment.  
frequency equipment.  
frequency equipment.  
The picture is  
disturbed.  
The video source uses scrambled or  
encoded signals to prevent dubbing.  
This unit suddenly  
enters the standby  
mode.  
The internal temperature becomes too  
high and the overheat protection circuitry  
has been activated.  
Wait about 1 hour for this unit to cool down and then  
turn it back on.  
Tuner  
Problem  
noisy.  
See  
page  
Cause  
Remedy  
FM stereo reception is  
The characteristics of FM stereo  
broadcasts may cause this problem  
when the transmitter is too far away or  
the antenna input is poor.  
Check the antenna connections.  
27  
Try using a high-quality directional FM  
antenna.  
Use the manual tuning method.  
55  
There is distortion, and  
There is multi-path interference.  
The signal is too weak.  
Adjust the antenna position to eliminate  
multi-path interference.  
clear reception cannot  
be obtained even with a  
good FM antenna.  
FM  
The desired station  
cannot be tuned into  
with the automatic  
tuning method.  
Use a high-quality directional FM antenna.  
Use the manual tuning method.  
55  
Previously preset  
stations can no longer  
be tuned into.  
This unit has been disconnected for a  
long period.  
Preset the stations again.  
56, 57  
The desired station  
cannot be tuned into  
with the automatic  
tuning method.  
The signal is weak or the antenna  
connections are loose.  
Tighten the AM loop antenna connections  
and orient it for the best reception.  
Use the manual tuning method.  
55  
AM  
There are continuous  
crackling and hissing  
noises.  
Noises can result from lightning,  
fluorescent lamps, motors, thermostats  
and other electrical equipment.  
Use an outdoor antenna and a ground wire.  
This will help somewhat, but it is difficult to  
eliminate all noise.  
There are buzzing and  
whining noises.  
A TV set is being used nearby.  
Move this unit away from the TV set.  
125 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
XM Satellite Radio  
If an operation takes longer than usual or an error occurs, one of the following messages may appear in the front panel  
display. In this case, read the cause and follow the corresponding remedies.  
See  
page  
Status message  
Cause  
Remedy  
The XM Passport and XM Passport Home Check XM Passport and XM Passport Home Dock  
Dock are not connected to the XM jack of connections and orient for the best reception level.  
this unit or do not work properly.  
60  
CHECK ANTENNA  
The XM user encryption code is being  
updated.  
Wait until the encryption code is updated.  
60  
UPDATING  
NO SIGNAL  
LOADING  
OFF AIR  
The signal is too weak.  
Adjust the orientation of the XM Passport System for  
the best reception level.  
It takes longer than four seconds for audio Wait until the decoding process has finished.  
or text data to be decoded.  
The XM Satellite Radio channel you  
selected is not currently broadcasting any  
signals.  
Check the channel number again or select another  
XM Satellite Radio channel.  
The Channel Station ID (SID) is no longer  
available.  
<XM> - - -  
No artist name or song title is available.  
- - - / - - -  
<CAT> - - -  
No channels are available for the selected  
category.  
Select another channel category by pressing  
CATEGORY on the front panel (or A-E/CAT. j/ ion  
the remote control) repeatedly.  
66  
126 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
Remote control  
See  
page  
Problem  
Cause  
Remedy  
The remote control  
does not work or  
function properly.  
Wrong distance or angle.  
The remote control will function within a maximum  
range of 6 m (20 ft) and no more than 30 degrees off-  
axis from the front panel.  
8
Direct sunlight or lighting (from an  
inverter type of fluorescent lamp, etc.) is  
striking the remote control sensor of this  
unit.  
Reposition this unit.  
8
The batteries are weak.  
Replace all batteries.  
The operation mode selector is set  
incorrectly.  
Set the operation mode selector correctly.  
When operating this unit, set it to the AMP position.  
When operating the component selected by the input  
selector button, set it to the SOURCE position.  
When operating the TV set in the DTV or PHONO  
area, set it to the TV position.  
The remote control code was not correctly Set the remote control code correctly using “LIST OF  
set.  
REMOTE CONTROL CODES” at the end of this  
manual.  
102  
102  
Try setting another code of the same manufacturer  
using “LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL CODES” at  
the end of this manual.  
The library code of the remote control and Match the remote control ID of this unit with the  
the remote control ID of this unit do not  
match.  
corresponding remote control library code.  
103, 118  
104  
Even if the remote control code is  
correctly set, there are some models that  
do not respond to the remote control.  
Program the necessary functions independently into  
the programmable buttons using the Learn feature.  
The remote control  
does not learn new  
functions.  
The batteries of this remote control and/or Replace the batteries.  
the other remote control are too weak.  
8
The distance between the two remote  
controls is too much or too little.  
Place the remote controls at the proper distance.  
104  
The signal coding or modulation of the  
other remote control is not compatible  
with this remote control.  
Learning is not possible.  
Memory capacity is full.  
Delete other unnecessary functions to make room for  
the new functions.  
109  
127 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
HDMI  
See  
page  
Error message  
DEVICE OVER  
HDCP ERROR  
Cause  
Remedy  
The number of the connected HDMI  
components is over the limit.  
Reduce the number of the connected HDMI  
components.  
Check that the connected HDMI components support  
the HDCP copy protection standards.  
HDCP authentication failed.  
iPod  
Note  
In case of a transmission error without a status message appearing in the front panel and in the OSD, check the connection to your iPod  
(see page 26).  
See  
page  
Status message  
Cause  
Remedy  
This unit is in the middle of recognizing  
the connection with your iPod.  
Loading...  
This unit is in the middle of acquiring  
song lists from your iPod.  
There is a problem with the signal path  
from your iPod to this unit.  
Turn off this unit and reconnect the YAMAHA iPod  
universal dock to the DOCK terminal of this unit.  
26  
Connect error  
Try resetting your iPod.  
The iPod being used is not supported by  
this unit.  
Only iPod (Click and Wheel), iPod nano, and iPod  
mini are supported.  
Unknown type  
Your iPod is properly stationed in a  
YAMAHA iPod universal dock (such as  
the YDS-10, sold separately) connected to  
the DOCK terminal of this unit, and the  
connection between your iPod and this  
unit is complete.  
iPod connected  
Your iPod was removed from a YAMAHA Station your iPod back in a YAMAHA iPod universal  
iPod universal dock (such as YDS-10 sold dock (such as YDS-10 sold separately) connected to  
26  
Disconnected  
separately) connected to the DOCK  
terminal of this unit.  
the DOCK terminal of this unit.  
This unit cannot play back the songs  
currently stored on your iPod.  
Check that the songs currently stored on your iPod  
are playable.  
Unable to play  
Store some other playable music files on your iPod.  
AUTO SETUP  
Before AUTO SETUP  
See  
page  
Error message  
Cause  
Remedy  
Optimizer microphone is not connected.  
Connect the supplied optimizer microphone  
to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front  
panel.  
Connect MIC!  
31  
Headphones are connected.  
Unplug the headphones.  
Unplug HP!  
128 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TROUBLESHOOTING  
During AUTO SETUP  
Error message  
See  
page  
Cause  
Remedy  
Front L/R channel signals are not detected.  
A surround channel signal is not detected.  
A presence channel signal is not detected.  
Check the front L/R speaker connections.  
Check the surround speaker connections.  
Check the presence speaker connections.  
13  
13  
13  
E-1:NO FRONT SP  
E-2:NO SURR.SP  
E-3:NO PRNS. SP  
E-4:SBR->SBL  
Only right surround back channel signal is  
detected.  
Connect the surround back speaker to the  
LEFT SURROUND BACK SPEAKERS  
terminal if you only have one surround  
back speaker.  
13  
Background noise is too loud.  
Try running “AUTO SETUP” in a quiet  
environment.  
E-5:NOISY  
13  
31  
Turn off noisy electric equipment like air  
conditioners or move them away from the  
optimizer microphone.  
Surround back speakers are connected,  
though surround L/R speakers are not.  
Connect surround speakers when you use  
surround back speakers.  
E-6:CHECK SUR.  
E-7:NO MIC  
The optimizer microphone was unplugged  
during the “AUTO SETUP” procedure.  
Connect the supplied optimizer microphone  
to the OPTIMIZER MIC jack on the front  
panel.  
The optimizer microphone does not detect  
test tones.  
Check the microphone setting.  
31  
13  
E-8:NO SIGNAL  
Check the speaker connections and  
placement.  
The “AUTO SETUP” procedure was  
cancelled due to user activity.  
Run “AUTO SETUP” again.  
E-9:USER CANCEL  
31  
31  
An internal error occurred.  
Run “AUTO SETUP” again.  
E-10:INTERNAL ERROR  
After AUTO SETUP  
See  
page  
Warning message  
Cause  
Remedy  
Speaker polarity is not correct. This  
message may appear depending on the  
speakers even when the speakers are  
connected correctly.  
Check the speaker connections for proper  
polarity (+ or –).  
W-1:OUT OF PHASE  
13  
The distance between the speaker and the  
listening position is over 24 m (80 ft).  
Bring the speaker closer to the listening  
position.  
W-2:OVER 24m (80ft)  
W-3:LEVEL ERROR  
The difference of volume level among  
speakers is excessive.  
Readjust the speaker installation so that all  
speakers are set in locations with similar  
conditions.  
Check the speaker connections.  
13  
31  
Use speakers of similar quality.  
Adjust the output volume of the subwoofer.  
Notes  
• If the “ERROR” or “WARNING” screens appears, check the cause of the problem, then run “AUTO SETUP” again.  
• If warning “W-1” appears, corrections are made, but they may not be optimal.  
• If warning “W-2” or “W-3” appears, no corrections are made.  
• If error “E-10” occurs repeatedly, please contact a qualified YAMAHA service center.  
129 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RESETTING THE SYSTEM  
RESETTING THE SYSTEM  
Use this feature to reset all the parameters of this unit to the initial factory settings.  
Notes  
• This procedure completely resets all the parameters of this unit including the “SET MENU” parameters. However, the advanced setup  
menu parameters will not be initialized.  
• The initial factory settings are activated next time you turn on this unit.  
y
To cancel the initialization procedure at any time without making any changes, press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to release it  
outward to the OFF position.  
3
Rotate the PROGRAM selector on the front  
panel to select “PRESET”.  
VOLUME  
MAIN ZONE  
ON/OFF  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
CONTROLS  
PROGRAM  
ON/OFF  
ON  
OFF  
PRESET/TUNING  
H M  
FM/AM  
A/B/C/D/E  
PRESET/TUNING/CH  
MEMORY  
TUNINIG MODE  
MASTER  
S
E
A
R
C
O
D
E
C
A
T
E
G
O
R
Y
DI  
S
P
L
A
Y
EDIT  
MAN'L/AUTO FM  
OPTIMIZER MIC  
PROGRAM  
INPUT  
VIDEO AUX  
PHONES  
ENHANCER  
NIGHT  
PURE DIRECT  
STRAIGHT  
EFFECT  
TONE CONTROL  
AUDIO SELECT  
ZONE  
2
ZONE  
2
VOLUME  
INPUT  
SILENT CINEMA  
S
V
I
D
E
O
V
I
D
E
O
L
AU  
D
I
O
R
O
P
T
I
C
A
L
2,4 3  
1-2,5  
USERꢀPRESET  
CANCEL  
1
2
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to turn  
off this unit.  
4
Press STRAIGHT on the front panel  
repeatedly to select “RESET”.  
MASTER  
STRAIGHT  
Press and hold STRAIGHT on the front panel  
and then press MASTER ON/OFF inward to  
the ON position to turn on this unit.  
This unit turns on, and the advanced setup menu  
appears in the front panel display.  
EFFECT  
While holding  
STRAIGHT  
USERꢀPRESET  
RESET  
down  
EFFECT  
MASTER  
y
Select “CANCEL” to cancel the initialization procedure  
without making any changes.  
5
Press MASTER ON/OFF on the front panel to  
release it outward to the OFF position to  
confirm your selection and turn off this unit.  
MASTER  
130 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GLOSSARY  
GLOSSARY  
Bi-amplification connection  
Dolby Digital  
A bi-amplification connection uses two amplifiers for a  
speaker. One amplifier is connected to the woofer section  
of a loudspeaker while the other is connected to the  
combined mid and tweeter section. With this arrangement  
each amplifier operates over a restricted frequency range.  
This restricted range presents each amplifier with a much  
simpler job and each amplifier is less likely to influence  
the sound in some way. The internal crossover of the  
speaker consists of a LPF (low pass filter) and a HPF (high  
pass filter). As its name implies, the LPF passes  
frequencies below a cutoff and rejects frequencies above  
the cutoff frequency. Likewise, the HPF passes  
Dolby Digital is a digital surround sound system that gives  
you completely independent multi-channel audio. With 3  
front channels (front L/R and center), and 2 surround  
stereo channels, Dolby Digital provides 5 full-range audio  
channels. With an additional channel especially for bass  
effects, called LFE (Low Frequency Effect), the system  
has a total of 5.1-channels (LFE is counted as 0.1  
channel). By using 2-channel stereo for the surround  
speakers, more accurate moving sound effects and  
surround sound environment are possible than with Dolby  
Surround. The wide dynamic range from maximum to  
minimum volume reproduced by the 5 full-range channels  
and the precise sound orientation generated using digital  
sound processing provide listeners with unprecedented  
excitement and realism. With this unit, any sound  
environment from monaural up to a 5.1-channel  
frequencies above its cutoff.  
Component video signal  
With the component video signal system, the video signal  
is separated into the Y signal for the luminance and the PB  
and PR signals for the chrominance. Color can be  
reproduced more faithfully with this system because each  
of these signals is independent. The component signal is  
also called the “color difference signal” because the  
luminance signal is subtracted from the color signal. A  
monitor with component input jacks is required in order to  
output component signals.  
configuration can be freely selected for your enjoyment.  
Dolby Digital EX  
Dolby Digital EX creates 6 full-bandwidth output  
channels from 5.1-channel sources. This is done using a  
matrix decoder that derives 3 surround channels from the  
2 in the original recording. For the best results, Dolby  
Digital EX should be used with movie sound tracks  
recorded with Dolby Digital Surround EX. With this  
additional channel, you can experience more dynamic and  
realistic moving sound especially with scenes with “fly-  
over” and “fly-around” effects.  
Composite video signal  
With the composite video signal system, the video signal  
is composed of three basic elements of a video picture:  
color, brightness and synchronization data. A composite  
video jack on a video component transmits these three  
elements combined.  
Dolby Pro Logic II  
Dolby Pro Logic II is an improved technique used to  
decode vast numbers of existing Dolby Surround sources.  
This new technology enables a discrete 5-channel  
playback with 2 front left and right channels, 1 center  
channel, and 2 surround left and right channels instead of  
only 1 surround channel for conventional Pro Logic  
technology. There are three modes available: “Music  
mode” for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie  
sources and “Game mode” for game sources.  
Dialogue normalization  
Dialogue Normalization is a feature of Dolby Digital or  
DTS, which is used to keep the programs at the same  
average listening level so the user does not have to change  
the volume control between Dolby Digital or DTS  
programs.  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx  
Dolby Pro Logic IIx is a new technology enabling discrete  
multi-channel playback from 2-channel or multi-channel  
sources. There are three modes available: “Music mode”  
for music sources, “Movie mode” for movie sources (for  
2-channel sources only) and “Game mode” for game  
sources.  
131 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GLOSSARY  
Dolby Surround  
HDMI  
Dolby Surround uses a 4-channel analog recording system  
to reproduce realistic and dynamic sound effects: 2 front  
left and right channels (stereo), a center channel for dialog  
(monaural), and a surround channel for special sound  
effects (monaural). The surround channel reproduces  
sound within a narrow frequency range. Dolby Surround is  
widely used with nearly all video tapes and laser discs,  
and in many TV and cable broadcasts as well. The Dolby  
Pro Logic decoder built into this unit employs a digital  
signal processing system that automatically stabilizes the  
volume on each channel to enhance moving sound effects  
and directionality.  
HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) is the first  
industry-supported, uncompressed, all-digital audio/video  
interface. Providing an interface between any source (such  
as a set-top box or AV receiver) and an audio/video  
monitor (such as a digital television), HDMI supports  
standard, enhanced or high-definition video as well as  
multi-channel digital audio using a single cable. HDMI  
transmits all ATSC HDTV standards and supports 8-  
channel digital audio, with bandwidth to spare to  
accommodate future enhancements and requirements.  
When used in combination with HDCP (High-bandwidth  
Digital Content Protection), HDMI provides a secure  
audio/video interface that meets the security requirements  
of content providers and system operators. For further  
information on HDMI, visit the HDMI website at “http://  
www.hdmi.org/”.  
DSD  
Direct Stream Digital (DSD) technology stores audio  
signals on digital storage media, such as Super Audio  
CDs. Using DSD, signals are stored as single bit values at  
a high-frequency sampling rate of 2.8224 MHz, while  
noise shaping and oversampling are used to reduce  
distortion, a common occurrence with very high  
quantization of audio signals. Due to the high sampling  
rate, better audio quality can be achieved than that offered  
by the PCM format used for normal audio CDs.  
LFE 0.1 channel  
This channel reproduces low-frequency signals. The  
frequency range of this channel is from 20 Hz to 120 Hz.  
This channel is counted as 0.1 because it only enforces a  
low-frequency range compared to the full-range  
reproduced by the other 5/6 channels in Dolby Digital or  
DTS 5.1/6.1-channel systems.  
DTS 96/24  
Neo:6  
DTS 96/24 offers an unprecedented level of audio quality  
for multi-channel sound on DVD video, and is fully  
backward-compatible with all DTS decoders. “96” refers  
to a 96 kHz sampling rate compared to the typical 48 kHz  
sampling rate. “24” refers to 24-bit word length. DTS 96/  
24 offers sound quality transparent to the original 96/24  
master, and 96/24 5.1-channel sound with full-quality full-  
motion video for music programs and motion picture  
soundtracks on DVD video.  
Neo:6 decodes the conventional 2-channel sources for 6-  
channel playback by the specific decoder. It enables  
playback with the full-range channels with higher  
separation just like digital discrete signal playback. There  
are two modes available: “Music mode” for music sources  
and “Cinema mode” for movie sources.  
Neural Surround  
Neural Surround represents the latest advancement in  
DTS (Digital Theater Systems) Digital  
Surround  
surround technology and has been adopted by XM  
Satellite Radio for digital radio broadcast of surround  
recordings and live events in surround sound. Neural  
DTS digital surround was developed to replace the analog  
soundtracks of movies with a 6.1-channel digital sound  
track, and is now rapidly gaining popularity in movie  
theaters around the world. Digital Theater Systems Inc.  
has developed a home theater system so that you can enjoy  
the depth of sound and natural spatial representation of  
DTS digital surround in your home. This system produces  
practically distortion-free 6.1-channel sound (technically,  
front left and right, center, surround left and right, and  
LFE 0.1 (subwoofer) channels for a total of 5.1 channels).  
This unit incorporates a DTS-ES decoder that enables 6.1-  
channel reproduction by adding the surround back channel  
to the existing 5.1-channel format.  
Surround employs psychoacoustic frequency domain  
processing which allows delivery of a more detailed sound  
stage with superior channel separation and localization of  
audio elements. System playback is scalable from 5.1 to  
7.1 multi-channel surround playback.  
PCM (Linear PCM)  
Linear PCM is a signal format under which an analog  
audio signal is digitized, recorded and transmitted without  
using any compression. This is used as a method of  
recording CDs and DVD audio. The PCM system uses a  
technique for sampling the size of the analog signal per  
very small unit of time. Standing for “Pulse Code  
Modulation”, the analog signal is encoded as pulses and  
then modulated for recording.  
132 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GLOSSARY  
Sampling frequency and number of  
quantized bits  
When digitizing an analog audio signal, the number of  
times the signal is sampled per second is called the  
sampling frequency, while the degree of fineness when  
converting the sound level into a numeric value is called  
the number of quantized bits. The range of rates that can  
be played back is determined based on the sampling rate,  
while the dynamic range representing the sound level  
difference is determined by the number of quantized bits.  
In principle, the higher the sampling frequency, the wider  
the range of frequencies that can be played back, and the  
higher the number of quantized bits, the more finely the  
sound level can be reproduced.  
S-video signal  
With the S-video signal system, the video signal normally  
transmitted using a pin cable is separated and transmitted  
as the Y signal for the luminance and the C signal for the  
chrominance through the S-video cable. Using the S  
VIDEO jack eliminates video signal transmission loss and  
allows recording and playback of even more beautiful  
images.  
133 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM INFORMATION  
SOUND FIELD PROGRAM INFORMATION  
Elements of a sound field  
SILENT CINEMA  
What really creates the rich, full tones of a live instrument  
are the multiple reflections from the walls of the room. In  
addition to making the sound live, these reflections enable  
us to tell where the player is situated as well as the size  
and shape of the room in which we are sitting.  
There are two distinct types of sound reflections that  
combine to make up the sound field in addition to the  
direct sound coming straight to our ears from the player’s  
instrument.  
YAMAHA has developed a natural, realistic sound effect  
DSP algorithm for headphones. Parameters for  
headphones have been set for each sound field so that  
accurate representations of all the sound field programs  
can be enjoyed on headphones.  
Virtual CINEMA DSP  
YAMAHA has developed a Virtual CINEMA DSP  
algorithm that allows you to enjoy DSP sound field  
surround effects even without any surround speakers by  
using virtual surround speakers. It is even possible to  
enjoy Virtual CINEMA DSP using a minimal two-speaker  
system that does not include a center speaker.  
Early reflections  
Reflected sounds reach our ears extremely rapidly (50 ms  
to 100 ms after the direct sound), after reflecting from one  
surface only (for example, from a wall or the ceiling).  
Early reflections actually add clarity to the direct sound.  
Sound output from each speaker  
Sound output from each speaker depends on the type of  
audio signals being input. Refer to the diagrams in the  
table below to understand the speaker layout for each  
sound field program. For details about the sound output  
from each speaker in sound field programs, refer to  
“SOUND OUTPUT IN EACH SOUND FIELD  
Reverberations  
These are caused by reflections from more than one  
surface (for example, from the walls, and the ceiling) so  
numerous that they merge together to form a continuous  
sonic afterglow. They are non-directional and lessen the  
clarity of the direct sound.  
PROGRAM” in “APPENDIX” at the end of this manual.  
Direct sound, early reflections and subsequent  
reverberations taken together help us to determine the  
subjective size and shape of the room, and it is this  
information that the digital sound field processor  
reproduces in order to create sound fields.  
Note  
Be advised that there may be no or not enough sound output from  
speakers depending on the type of input source being played  
back. Furthermore, there may be some channels that can only be  
used partially when they are adjusted to specific aspects of  
movies, such as special sound effects, etc.  
If you could create the appropriate early reflections and  
subsequent reverberations in your listening room, you  
would be able to create your own listening environment.  
The acoustics in your room could be changed to those of a  
concert hall, a dance floor, or a room with virtually any  
size at all. This ability to create sound fields at will is  
exactly what YAMAHA has done with the digital sound  
field processor.  
y
Except for “2ch Stereo”, “7ch Stereo”, and “STRAIGHT”, you  
can select a decoder to output sound from the surround back  
speakers (see page 44).  
CINEMA DSP  
Since the Dolby Surround and DTS systems were  
originally designed for use in movie theaters, their effect  
is best felt in a theater having many speakers designed for  
acoustic effects. Since home conditions, such as room  
size, wall material, number of speakers, and so on, can  
differ so widely, it is inevitable that there are differences in  
the sound heard. Based on a wealth of actually measured  
data, YAMAHA CINEMA DSP uses YAMAHA original  
sound field technology to combine Dolby Pro Logic,  
Dolby Digital and DTS systems to provide the audiovisual  
experience of a movie theater in the listening room of your  
own home.  
134 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PARAMETRIC EQUALIZER INFORMATION  
PARAMETRIC EQUALIZER INFORMATION  
This unit employs YAMAHA Parametric Room Acoustic  
Q factor  
Optimizer (YPAO) technology, together with the  
Parametric EQ settings (see page 90), to optimize the  
frequency characteristics of its parametric equalizer to  
match your listening environment. YPAO uses a  
combination of the following three parameters  
(Frequency, Gain and Q factor) to provide highly precise  
adjustment of the frequency characteristics.  
The width of the specified frequency band is referred to as  
the Q factor. This parameter is adjustable between the  
values 0.5 and 10.  
Frequency  
This parameter is adjustable in one-third octave  
increments between 32 Hz and 16 kHz.  
YPAO adjusts frequency characteristics to suit your  
listening requirements using a combination of the above  
three parameters (Frequency, Gain and Q factor) for each  
equalizer band in this unit’s parametric equalizer. This unit  
has 7 equalizer bands for each channel.  
The use of multiple equalizer bands enables more precise  
adjustments of frequency characteristics (as in Figure 2).  
This is not possible using only a single equalizer band (as  
in Figure 1).  
Gain  
This parameter is adjustable in increments of 0.5 dB  
between –20 and +6 dB.  
Figure 1  
Gain  
Frequency  
characteristic after  
correction  
Band 1  
Frequency  
Original frequency  
characteristic  
Figure 2  
Gain  
Frequency  
characteristic after  
correction  
Band 1  
Frequency  
Original frequency  
characteristic  
Band 2  
135 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SPECIFICATIONS  
SPECIFICATIONS  
AUDIO SECTION  
• Minimum RMS Output Power for Front, Center, Surround,  
Surround back  
VIDEO SECTION  
• Video Format (Gray Back) ..................................................... NTSC  
• Video Format (Video Conversion) ................................. NTSC/PAL  
20 Hz to 20 kHz, 0.04% THD, 8 .................................... 120 W  
• Signal Level  
• Dynamic Power (IHF)  
Composite ................................................................. 1 Vp-p/75 Ω  
S-video ............................ 1 Vp-p/75 (Y), 0.286 Vp-p/75 (C)  
Component ................... 1 Vp-p/75 (Y), 0.7 Vp-p/75 (PB/PR)  
8/6/4/2 ....................................................... 155/195/250/330 W  
• Dynamic Headroom  
8 ........................................................................................1.1 dB  
• Maximum Input Level (V CONV. off) ................. 1.5 Vp-p or more  
• Signal to Noise Ratio (V CONV. off) ........................ 60 dB or more  
• Damping Factor (IHF)  
Front L/R, 20 Hz to 20 kHz, 8 ................................150 or more  
• Frequency Response (MONITOR OUT)  
• Input Sensitivity/Input Impedance  
Component (V CONV. off) .................... 5 Hz to 100 MHz, 3 dB  
PHONO .................................................................. 3.5 mV/47 kΩ  
CD, etc. ................................................................. 200 mV/47 kΩ  
MULTI CH INPUT ............................................... 200 mV/47 kΩ  
FM SECTION  
• Tuning Range ..................................................... 87.5 to 107.9 MHz  
• Maximum Input Signal  
• 50 dB Quieting Sensitivity (IHF)  
PHONO (1 kHz, 0.1% THD) ................................ 60 mV or more  
CD, etc. (1 kHz, 0.5% THD) ................................... 2.4 V or more  
Mono/Stereo ........................................ 2.0/25 µV (17.3/39.2 dBf)  
• Usable Sensitivity (IHF) ...................................... 1.0 µV (11.2 dBf)  
• Selectivity (400 kHz) .............................................................. 70 dB  
• Output Level/Output Impedance  
OUT (REC) ........................................................... 200 mV/900 Ω  
PRE OUT (20 Hz)..................................................... 1.0 V/1.2 kΩ  
SUBWOOFER ......................................................... 2.0 V/1.2 kΩ  
ZONE 2 OUT ........................................................... 1.0 V/1.4 kΩ  
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF)  
Mono/Stereo ............................................................. 76 dB/70 dB  
• Harmonic Distortion (1 kHz)  
• Headphone Jack Rated Output/Impedance  
Mono/Stereo ................................................................... 0.2/0.3%  
CD, etc. (1 kHz, 40 mV, 8 ) ................................ 150 mV/100 Ω  
• Stereo Separation (1 kHz)  
• Frequency Response  
Stereo .................................................................................... 42 dB  
CD to Front L/R, Pure Direct ........... 10 Hz to 100 kHz, +0/–3 dB  
• Frequency Response  
• RIAA Equalization Deviation  
Stereo ............................................. 20 Hz to 15 kHz, +0.5, –2 dB  
PHONO (20 Hz to 20 kHz) .......................................... 0 0.5 dB  
• Antenna Input (unbalanced) ..................................................... 75 Ω  
• Total Harmonic Distortion  
PHONO to OUT (REC)  
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 1 V) .......................................... 0.02% or less  
CD, etc. to Front L/R  
AM SECTION  
• Tuning Range ......................................................... 530 to 1710 kHz  
(20 Hz to 20 kHz, 65 W, 8 Ω) ............................... 0.04% or less  
• Usable Sensitivity ............................................................. 300 µV/m  
• Signal to Noise Ratio (IHF-A Network)  
GENERAL  
PHONO (5 mV) to Front L/R .................................86 dB or more  
CD, etc. (250 mV) to Front L/R ............................100 dB or more  
• Power Supply ........................................................ AC 120 V, 60 Hz  
• Power Consumption .................................................. 500 W/630 VA  
• Standby Power Consumption ...................................... 0.1 W or less  
• AC Outlets ................................... 2 (Total 100 W/0.8 A maximum)  
• Residual Noise (IHF-A Network)  
Front L/R ................................................................ 150 µV or less  
• Channel Separation (1 kHz/10 kHz)  
PHONO (shortened) to Front L/R ............... 60 dB/55 dB or more  
CD, etc.  
(5.1 kshortened) to Front L/R .............. 60 dB/45 dB or more  
• Dimensions (W x H x D) ................................. 435 x 171 x 424 mm  
(17.1 x 6.7 x 16.7 in)  
• Weight .................................................................. 16.2 kg (36.0 lbs)  
* Specifications are subject to change without notice.  
We Want You Listening For A Lifetime  
• Tone Control Characteristics (Front L/R)  
BASS Boost/Cut ........................................................ 6 dB/50 Hz  
BASS Turnover Frequency .................................................350 Hz  
TREBLE Boost/Cut ................................................ 6 dB/20 kHz  
TREBLE Turnover Frequency ...........................................3.5 kHz  
• Zone 2 Tone Control Characteristics (Front L/R)  
YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries  
Association’s Consumer Electronics Group want  
you to get the most out of your equipment by  
playing it at a safe level. One that lets the sound  
come through loud and clear without annoying  
BASS Boost/Cut .................................................... 10 dB/100 Hz  
BASS Turnover Frequency .................................................450 Hz  
TREBLE Boost/Cut .............................................. 10 dB/10 kHz  
TREBLE Turnover Frequency ...........................................2.0 kHz  
• Filter Characteristics (fc=40/60/80/90/100/110/120/160/200 Hz)  
H.P.F. (Front, Center, Surround, Surround back) ...........12 dB/oct.  
L.P.F. (Subwoofer) .........................................................24 dB/oct.  
blaring or distortion – and, most importantly,  
without affecting your sensitive hearing. Since hearing damage  
from loud sounds is often undetectable until it is too late,  
YAMAHA and the Electronic Industries Association’s Consumer  
Electronics Group recommend you to avoid prolonged exposure  
from excessive volume levels.  
136 En  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOUND OUTPUT IN EACH SOUND FIELD PROGRAM  
L
C
R
SL  
SR  
SBL  
SBR  
PL  
PR  
Front left speaker  
Center speaker  
Surround left speaker  
Surround back right speaker  
Presence left speaker  
Surround right speaker  
Surround back left speaker  
Front right speaker  
Presence right speaker  
Speaker from which no sound is being output  
Speaker from which sound is being output  
*1  
*2  
*3  
EX  
EX  
EX  
PL  
PL  
PL  
x
x
x
/
/
/
/
: OFF  
/
/
: ON, PRIORITY: PRNS  
: ON, PRIORITY: SB  
Input source  
Program  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *1  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *2  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *3  
2-channelaudio  
(monaural)  
2-channelaudio  
(stereo)  
CLASSICAL  
Hall in Munich  
Hall in Vienna  
Hall in  
Amsterdam  
Church in  
Freiburg  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
Chamber  
LIVE/CLUB  
Village  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
Vanguard  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Warehouse Loft  
Cellar Club  
The Roxy  
Theatre  
The Bottom Line  
ENTERTAINMENT  
Sports  
Action Game  
Roleplaying  
Game  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
Music Video  
Recital/Opera  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
MOVIE  
STANDARD  
(PRO LOGIC)  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
(Dolby Digital)  
(Dolby Digital)  
(Dolby Digital)  
/
/
/
(DTS)  
(DTS)  
(DTS)  
APPENDIX-i  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input source  
Program  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *1  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *2  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *3  
2-channelaudio  
(monaural)  
2-channelaudio  
(stereo)  
MOVIE  
STANDARD  
(PLII Movie)  
PL PR  
C
PL PR  
C
PL PR  
C
PL PR  
C
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
(PLIIx Movie)  
(Neo:6 Cinema)  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
PRIORITY: PRNS  
(Dolby Digital)  
(Dolby Digital)  
(Dolby Digital)  
/
/
/
(DTS)  
(DTS)  
(DTS)  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
PRIORITY: SB  
MOVIE  
Spectacle  
Sci-Fi  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
Adventure  
Drama  
Mono Movie  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
STEREO  
2ch Stereo  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Monaural playback  
STEREO  
7ch Stereo  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
APPENDIX-ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input source  
Program  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *1  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *2  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *3  
2-channelaudio  
(monaural)  
2-channelaudio  
(stereo)  
SURROUND DECODE  
PRO LOGIC  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
PRO LOGIC  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
Dolby Digital  
/
DTS  
SURROUND DECODE  
PLII Movie  
PLII Music  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
PLII Game  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Movie/Game  
Movie/Music/Game  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
Music  
SURROUND DECODE  
PLIIx Movie  
PLIIx Music  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
PLIIx Game  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Movie/Game  
Movie/Music/Game  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
Music  
APPENDIX-iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Input source  
Program  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *1  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *2  
5.1/6.1-channel  
audio *3  
2-channelaudio  
(monaural)  
2-channelaudio  
(stereo)  
SURROUND DECODE  
Neo:6 Cinema  
Neo:6 Music  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Cinema  
Cinema/Music  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
PL  
PR  
C
L
R
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
Music  
SURROUND DECODE  
neural sur.  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
Dolby Digital  
/
/
/
DTS  
DTS  
DTS  
STRAIGHT  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Monaural playback  
PURE DIRECT  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
PL  
PR  
C
C
C
C
C
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SL  
SR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
SBL SBR  
Monaural playback  
APPENDIX-iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LIST OF REMOTE CONTROL CODES  
CALIFORNIA AUDIO LABS  
SM ELECTRONIC 0757  
CABLE  
ABC  
CD RECORDER  
0056  
SAMSUNG  
SANYO  
SHARP  
0600  
0697  
0657  
0030, 0035  
CARVER  
CYRUS  
DKK  
0184, 0206  
0184  
0027  
KENWOOD  
MARANTZ  
PHILIPS  
0653  
0653  
0653  
2400  
AMERICAST 0926  
BELL SOUTH 0926  
BIRMINGHAM CABLE  
COMMUNICATIONS  
0303  
BRITISH TELECOM 0030  
CABLE & WIRELESS  
1095  
DAERYUNG 0035, 0504, 0904,  
1904  
DIRECTOR  
FILMNET  
SHERWOOD 0797  
SHINSONIC 0560  
DMX ELECTRONICS  
0184  
YAMAHA  
SLIM ART  
SONY  
SYLVANIA  
TATUNG  
TEAC  
0811  
0560, 0891  
0702  
0797  
0598, 0744  
0517  
DENON  
0900  
DVD PLAYER  
ACOUSTIC SOLUTIONS  
DYNAMIC BASS  
0206  
EMERSON  
FISHER  
GENEXXA  
0332  
0206  
0059, 0332  
0757  
ALBA  
AMSTRAD  
0744  
0740  
TECHNICS  
GOODMANS 0332  
GRUNDIG 0184  
HARMAN/KARDON  
0184, 0200  
0059  
THETA DIGITAL  
0598  
0503  
0470  
APEX DIGITAL  
0699, 0744,  
0782, 0821, 0823,  
0857, 1127  
THOMSON  
TOSHIBA  
0549  
0530  
GENERAL INSTRUMENT  
0030, 0303, 0503,  
URBAN CONCEPTS 0530  
HITACHI  
JVC  
BLAUPINKT 0744  
BLUE PARADE  
XBOX  
0549  
0837,  
0099  
0598  
YAMAHA  
0517, 0566, 0572,  
2100  
GOLDSTAR 0171  
HAMLIN  
JERROLD  
KENWOOD  
KRELL  
LXI  
0055, 0064  
0184  
0332  
BUSH  
CENTREX  
0740  
0699  
0036, 0300  
0030, 0303, 0503,  
0837  
0171  
0470  
0027  
ZENITH  
ZEUS  
0530, 0618, 0768  
0811  
CLATRONIC 0815  
CYBERHOME 0741  
LINN  
0184  
LG  
MNET  
MEMOREX  
MOTOROLA 0303, 0503, 0837,  
1133  
NTL  
MCS  
0056  
DVD2000  
DAEWOO  
DANSAI  
0548  
0811, 0797  
0797  
DVD RECORDER  
MAGNAVOX 0184, 0332  
MARANTZ  
MATSUI  
0056, 0184  
0184  
HITACHI  
2815  
DECCA  
0797  
PANASONIC 2800, 2801, 2802  
MEMOREX  
MERIDIAN  
0332  
0184  
DENON  
0517  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
SHARP  
2808  
1095  
0844  
1095  
DIAMOND  
DIGITREX  
EMERSON  
0795  
0699  
0618  
2804, 2805, 2806  
2812, 2813  
2809, 2810, 2811  
2803  
2814  
2807  
NOOS  
ONO  
MICROMEGA 0184  
MIRO  
0027  
SONY  
PVP STEREO VISUAL MATRIX  
0030  
PACE  
MISSION  
MYRYAD  
NAD  
0184  
0184  
0027  
ENTERPRISE 0618  
TOSHIBA  
VICTOR  
YAMAHA  
FISHER  
GE  
GO VIDEO  
0697  
0549, 0744  
0742  
0264, 1087, 1095  
PANASONIC 0027, 0035, 0134  
NSM  
0184  
PARAGON  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
0027  
NAIM  
OPTIMUS  
0184  
0027, 0059, 0064,  
0206, 0332  
GOLDSTAR 0768  
GRADIENTE 0678  
GREENHILL 0744  
LD PLAYER  
0332, 0344  
0171, 0560, 0904,  
1904  
0027  
0027  
0300, 0306  
0027  
0844  
CARVER  
0091  
PANASONIC 0056  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
POLK AUDIO 0184  
PROTON  
QED  
QUAD  
QUASAR  
RCA  
REALISTIC  
REVOX  
ROTEL  
SAE  
SANSUI  
SANYO  
SCOTT  
SEARS  
SHARP  
SIMAUDIO  
GRUNDIG  
HITACHI  
HITEKER  
JVC  
0566  
0600, 0691  
0699  
0585, 0650  
0744  
DENON  
MARANTZ  
0086  
0091  
PULSAR  
QUASAR  
REGAL  
RUNCO  
SAGEM  
SAMSUNG  
SCIENTIFIC ATLANTA  
0035, 0504, 0904,  
0184  
0059, 0332  
MITSUBISHI 0086  
NAD  
0086  
0086  
0086  
0091  
0086  
0091  
0228  
0184  
0184  
0184  
0056  
0059, 0206, 0332  
0206  
0184  
0184  
0184  
0184, 0332  
0206  
0332  
0332  
0064  
KLH  
NAGSMI  
OPTIMUS  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
SALORA  
SONY  
KENWOOD  
KOSS  
0517, 0561  
0678  
0027, 0171  
LG  
0768  
LIMIT  
0795  
1904  
1033  
0030  
MAGNAVOX 0530, 0702  
SONY  
MARANTZ  
MEMOREX  
MICO  
0566  
0858  
0750  
TELEFUNKEN  
YAMAHA  
0086  
STARCOM  
SUPERCABLE  
TS  
TELE+1  
TELEWEST  
TORX  
TOSHIBA  
TRANS PX  
UNITED CABLE  
ZENITH  
2200  
0303  
0030  
0470  
1095  
0030  
0027  
0303  
MICROSOFT 0549  
MINTEK 0744  
MITSUBISHI 0548  
MD RECORDER  
KENWOOD  
ONKYO  
SHARP  
0708  
0895  
0888  
MUSTEK  
NESA  
ONKYO  
ORITRON  
PALSONIC  
0757  
0744  
0530  
0678  
0699  
0184  
SONY  
0517  
0030  
SONIC FRONTIERS 0184  
SONY 0027  
YAMAHA  
2500, 2501, 2502  
0027, 0552, 0926  
SYMPHONIC 0332  
TAG MCLAREN  
PANASONIC 0517, 0659, 1389  
RECEIVER (TUNER)  
0184  
PHILIPS  
0530, 0566, 0673,  
0881  
CD PLAYER  
TANDY  
0059  
0056  
0184  
0184  
ADC  
0558  
AIWA  
0184  
TECHNICS  
THORENS  
THULE  
PIONEER  
0552, 0598, 0658,  
0659  
AIWA  
0185, 1116, 1415,  
1432, 1668  
1417  
ARCAM  
0184  
AUDIO RESEARCH 0184  
AUDIO TON 0184  
POLK AUDIO 0566  
ALCO  
UNIVERSUM 0184  
PROSCAN  
QWESTAR  
RCA  
0549  
0678  
0549, 0598, 0744  
0650  
ANAM  
1636  
AUDIOLAB  
AUDIOMECA 0184  
CAIRN 0184  
0184  
VICTOR  
WARDS  
YAMAHA  
0099  
0184  
2300, 2301  
APEX DIGITAL  
AUDIOLAB  
AUDIOTRONIC  
1284  
1216  
ROTEL  
1216  
AUDIOVOX 1417  
BOSE  
1256  
APPENDIX-v  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CAMBRIDGE SOUNDWORKS  
1397  
CAPETRONIC 0558  
ATSAT  
AVALON  
1327  
0423  
ORBITECH  
PACE  
1127  
0482, 0874, 1202,  
1350  
TV  
AGB  
AOC  
BLAUPUNKT 0200  
BRITISH SKY BROADCASTING  
0874, 1202  
CANAL DIGITAL  
CANAL SATELLITE 0880  
CANAL+ 0880  
CHAPARRAL 0243  
CITYCOM  
CONNEXIONS  
CROSSDIGITAL  
0543  
CARVER  
CENTREX  
DENON  
1116, 1216  
1284  
1387  
PANASONIC 0274, 0728, 0874,  
1347  
PANDA  
PAYSAT  
PHILIPS  
0036, 0057, 0087,  
0119, 0120, 0135,  
0205, 0207, 0478  
0131  
0036  
0036  
0119, 0135, 0680  
0120, 0190, 0490  
0788  
0880  
0482  
0751  
0160, 0227, 0482,  
0749, 0751, 0776,  
0880, 1103, 1169,  
1776  
0880  
0482  
0419, 0593  
0170, 0419, 0593,  
0882  
FERGUSON 0558  
ASA  
AWA  
FINE ARTS  
GRUNDIG  
1216  
1216  
ACURA  
ADDISON  
ADMIRAL  
ADVENT  
AIKO  
HARMAN/KARDON  
0137, 1331  
1203  
0423  
1136  
INTEGRA  
JBL  
JVC  
0162, 1325  
0137, 1333  
0101, 0558, 1401,  
1522  
PIONEER  
PROMAX  
PROSCAN  
RCA  
CYRUS  
D-BOX  
DMT  
0227  
0750, 1154  
1102  
0119  
AKAI  
0036, 0057, 0235,  
0388, 0543, 0729,  
0839  
0291  
0036, 0064, 0398,  
0695  
KLH  
KENWOOD  
MCS  
1417, 1439  
1054, 1340  
0066  
DNT  
0227, 0423  
DAERYUNG 0423  
RFT  
0227  
AKURA  
ALBA  
DAEWOO  
DIGENIUS  
DIRECTV  
1323  
0326  
0274, 0419, 0593,  
0666, 0751, 0776,  
0846, 1103, 1136,  
1169, 1776, 1883  
RADIOSHACK  
RADIOLA  
RADIX  
0896  
MAGNAVOX 0558, 1116, 1216,  
1296,  
0227  
0423  
0874, 0883, 1202  
AMERICA ACTION 0207  
AMPRO  
AMSTRAD  
MARANTZ  
0066, 1116, 1216,  
1316  
SKY  
0778  
SM ELECTRONIC 1227  
SABRE  
SAGEM  
SAMSUNG  
0036, 0064, 0198,  
0398, 0439, 0460,  
0543  
MICROMEGA 1216  
MUSICMAGIC  
0482  
1116  
DISH NETWORK SYSTEM  
0802, 1032  
DISHPRO  
DISTRATEL 0111  
DREAM MULTIMEDIA  
1264  
0847, 1141, 1280  
1044, 1136, 1303,  
1319  
MYRYAD  
NAD  
NORCENT  
ONKYO  
OPTIMUS  
1216  
0347  
1416  
0162, 0869, 1325  
0558, 1050  
ANAM  
0036, 0207, 0277  
0802, 1032  
ANAM NATIONAL 0277, 0677  
ANITECH 0036  
APEX DIGITAL  
0794  
SAT CONTROL  
SATSTATION 1110  
SCHWAIGER 1138  
1327  
0775, 0792,  
PANASONIC 0066, 1315, 1545,  
1790  
ECHOSTAR 0194, 0423, 0637,  
0802, 0880, 0898,  
1032, 1113  
SEEMANN  
SIEMENS  
SONY  
STAR CHOICE  
STRONG  
TPS  
TANTEC  
TECHNISAT 1126, 1127  
TELESTAR  
THOMSON  
0423  
0200  
0666, 0874, 1666  
0896  
1327  
AUDIOSONIC 0064, 0136  
BANG & OLUFSEN 0592  
PHILIPS  
1116, 1216, 1293,  
1295, 1296, 1310,  
1316  
BASIC  
0036  
ENGEL  
1044  
BAUR  
BAYSONIC  
0064, 0388, 0539  
0207  
EXPRESSVU 0802  
PIONEER  
0041, 0558, 1050,  
1411  
FTE  
FINLUX  
0890  
0482  
0847, 1280  
0482  
BEAUMARK 0205  
BEKO 0397, 0513, 0741,  
0742  
BELL & HOWELL 0181  
BEON 0064  
BLAUPUNKT 0222  
POLK AUDIO 1316  
FRACARRO 0898  
PROSCAN  
QUASAR  
RCA  
1281  
0066  
0558, 1050, 1281,  
1417, 1636,  
0558  
FUBA  
GE  
0423  
0593  
1127  
0482, 0880, 1073,  
1318  
GOI  
0802  
GALAXIS  
0890, 1138  
TOPFIELD  
TOSHIBA  
ULTIMATETV  
UNIDEN  
UNIVERSUM 0200  
VENTANA  
WISI  
XSAT  
ZEHNDER  
ZENITH  
1233  
BLUE SKY  
0695, 1064  
SABA  
GENERAL INSTRUMENT  
0896  
0776, 0817, 1776  
0419, 0666  
0749, 0751  
BONDSTEC 0274  
BRADFORD 0207  
SANSUI  
1116  
SCHNEIDER 0558  
SONY 0185, 1085, 1185,  
1685, 1785  
STEREOPHONICS 1050  
GOLD BOX  
GRUNDIG  
HTS  
0880  
0200, 0874  
0802  
BRANDT  
0136, 0362  
BROKSONIC 0263, 0490  
0227  
0200, 0423, 0482  
0150  
1102  
0883, 1883  
BUSH  
0036, 0064, 0398,  
HIRSCHMANN  
HITACHI  
0200, 0423  
0482, 0846  
0401, 0695, 1064  
SUNFIRE  
TEAC  
1340  
1417  
CCE  
CGE  
CTC  
CXC  
0064  
0274  
0274  
0207  
0057  
HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEM  
0776, 1169, 1776  
TECHNICS  
0066, 1335, 1336,  
1545  
HUMAX  
INVIDEO  
JVC  
0890, 1203  
0898  
0802  
TELEFUNKEN  
THOMSON  
THORENS  
UHER  
0558  
CANDLE  
TAPE DECK  
AIWA  
CARVER  
GRUNDIG  
HARMAN/KARDON  
0056  
1281  
1216  
0558  
CARNIVALE 0057  
KATHREIN  
0150, 0200, 0227,  
0276, 0685, 1248  
0056  
0056  
0056  
CARVER  
CASCADE  
CATHAY  
0081, 0197  
0036  
0064  
VENTURER  
VICTOR  
1417  
0101  
KREISELMEYER  
0200  
LABGEAR  
LOGIX  
1323  
1044  
CELEBRITY 0027  
CELERA 0792  
CENTURION 0064  
CHANGHONG 0792  
WARDS  
YAMAHA  
0041, 0185  
0203, 1203, 1358,  
2601  
LORENZEN 0326  
MAGNAVOX 0749, 0751  
MAGNAVOX 0056  
MARANTZ  
MYRYAD  
OPTIMUS  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
POLK AUDIO 0056  
0056  
0056  
0054  
0056  
0054  
(TUNER ID1)  
(TUNER ID2)  
(XM ID1)  
(XM ID2)  
(iPod)  
2602  
2603  
2604  
2605  
MANHATTAN  
0482, 1044,  
CHING TAI  
CHUN YUN  
0036, 0119  
0027, 0036, 0119,  
0207  
1110  
0227  
0880  
0751  
0111  
MARANTZ  
MEDIASAT  
MEMOREX  
METRONIC  
CHUNG HSIN 0080, 0135, 0207  
2606  
CIMLINE  
CINERAL  
CITIZEN  
CLARION  
CLARIVOX  
0036  
RCA  
0054  
0056  
0056  
0270  
0056  
0054  
2700,2701  
0119, 0478  
0057, 0087, 0119  
0207  
MITSUBISHI 0776  
MOTOROLA 0896  
REVOX  
SANSUI  
SONY  
THORENS  
WARDS  
YAMAHA  
SATELLITE TUNER  
@SAT  
ABSAT  
ALBA  
1327  
0150  
0482  
MYRYAD  
0227  
0064  
NEXT LEVEL 0896  
CLATRONIC 0274, 0397  
NOKIA  
0482, 0750, 0778,  
CONDOR  
CONRAC  
0347, 0397  
0835  
ALPHASTAR 0799  
1154, 1250, 1750  
1032  
AMSTRAD  
ASTON  
ASTRO  
0874  
0169, 1156  
0200  
OCTALTV  
APPENDIX-vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GRANADA  
0064, 0235, 0366,  
0543  
0637  
0064, 0222, 0514,  
0583, 0614  
0207  
MAGNADYNE  
MAGNAFON 0543  
MAGNAVOX 0057, 0081, 1281,  
1481  
MANESTH  
MARANTZ  
0274, 0543  
PHILIPS  
0027, 0057, 0064,  
0078, 0081, 0119,  
0135, 0205, 0401,  
0583, 0717, 1481  
0064  
CONTEC  
CRAIG  
CROSLEY  
CROWN  
0036, 0207  
0207  
0081  
0036, 0064, 0207,  
0397, 0445  
GRANDIN  
GRUNDIG  
0291, 0347  
0057, 0064, 0081,  
0583  
PHONOLA  
PILOT  
PIONEER  
0057  
CURTIS MATHES 0057, 0074,  
0081, 0087, 0120,  
0172, 0181, 0193,  
0478, 0729, 1174,  
1374  
GRUNPY  
HCM  
HALLMARK 0205  
HANKOOK  
HANSEATIC 0064, 0347, 0388,  
0455, 0583  
HANTAREX 0543  
HARMAN/KARDON 0081  
HARVARD  
HAVERMY  
HELLO KITTY  
HINARI  
0136, 0190, 0193,  
0314, 0706, 0787,  
0893  
0036, 0439  
MARK  
MATSUI  
0064  
0057, 0205, 0207  
0036, 0064, 0235,  
0398, 0514, 0543  
0277, 0677  
PORTLAND 0119  
PRANDONI-PRINCE  
0543  
PRIMA  
PRISM  
PROFEX  
PROSCAN  
PROTECH  
MATSUSHITA  
MEDIATOR 0064  
MEDION  
MEGATRON 0172, 0205  
DAEWOO  
0036, 0057, 0064,  
0119, 0135, 0181,  
0197, 0205, 0207,  
0401, 0478, 0650,  
0661, 1688  
0064  
0695, 0835, 1064  
0788  
0078  
0207  
0120  
0478  
0036, 0064  
0482  
0036, 0057, 0119,  
0132, 0136, 0172,  
0190, 0205, 0252,  
0383, 0508, 0575,  
0605, 1172, 1283  
0036  
MEMOREX  
0036, 0177, 0181,  
0205, 0277, 0490,  
1064  
0474  
0835  
0036, 0388  
0074  
0036, 0064, 0274,  
0291, 0445, 0695  
0036, 0057, 0205  
0044  
0078, 0277, 0677  
0064, 0131, 0388,  
0539  
DANSAI  
DAYTON  
DE GRAAF  
DECCA  
DENON  
DIGATRON  
DIXI  
DUMONT  
DWIN  
ECE  
ELBE  
ELECTROBAND  
ELIN  
ELITE  
ELTA  
EMERSON  
0036  
HISAWA  
HITACHI  
METZ  
MICROMAXX  
MICROSTAR 0835  
MIDLAND  
MINERVA  
MINOKA  
MITSUBISHI 0057, 0120, 0135,  
0177, 0181, 0205,  
0235, 0575  
0064, 0543  
0172  
0064  
0036, 0064  
0044  
0747, 0801  
0064  
0286  
0027  
0064, 0575  
0347  
PROTON  
PULSAR  
QUASAR  
QUELLE  
0044, 0074, 0078  
0514  
0439  
R-LINE  
RCA  
0064  
HUA TUN  
HUANYU  
HYPSON  
ICE  
ITS  
ITT  
IMPERIAL  
INDIANA  
INFINITY  
INGELEN  
INNO HIT  
INNOVA  
INTEQ  
0027, 0057, 0074,  
0117, 0119, 0205,  
0706, 1074, 1174,  
1274, 1374, 1474,  
1481, 1574  
0455  
0057, 0074,  
0181, 0205, 0207  
0064  
0543  
0057, 0181, 0205,  
0207  
0388  
0741  
0401  
0064, 0291  
0291, 0398  
0398  
0190, 0388, 0575  
0274, 0397, 0445  
0064  
0081  
0190  
0543  
0064  
0207, 0263, 0277,  
0539, 0863, 1277  
0318,0319, 0543,  
0636  
MIVAR  
MOTOROLA 0120  
MULTITECH 0036, 0207  
MYRYAD  
NAD  
RFT  
RADIOSHACK  
0036  
0181, 0205, 0207,  
0263, 0388, 0490,  
0650  
0057,0840  
0860  
0064  
0036, 0057  
0036  
0583  
0183, 0205, 0388,  
0893  
0036, 0057, 0078,  
0181, 0183, 0197,  
0205, 0482, 0524,  
1731  
RADIOLA  
RADIOMARELLI  
REALISTIC  
ENVISION  
EPSON  
ERRES  
ETHER  
ETRON  
NEC  
0044  
REDIFFUSION  
REOC  
INTERFUNK 0064, 0190, 0274,  
0388, 0539  
INTERVISION  
0064, 0291,  
NEI  
NTC  
NECKERMANN  
NETSAT  
NEWAVE  
0064  
0119  
REVOX  
REX  
0064  
0190, 0286, 0291  
EUROPHON 0543  
FERGUSON 0064, 0100, 0136,  
0265, 0314, 0362,  
0404  
0081  
0027  
JBL  
JCB  
JVC  
0064, 0583  
ROADSTAR 0036, 0291, 0445  
RUNCO  
0064  
0036, 0119, 0120,  
0205  
0044, 0057, 0524,  
0630  
0064  
0291, 0695  
0543  
0064  
0207  
0136, 0190, 0314,  
0362  
0265  
0637  
0587  
FIDELITY  
0388  
0080, 0398, 0490,  
0680, 0710  
0036, 0078, 0119,  
0183, 0263  
0788  
SBR  
SEG  
SEI  
SKY  
SSS  
FINLANDIA 0235, 0373  
JEAN  
NIKKAI  
NIKKO  
NOKIA  
0064, 0291  
0057, 0119, 0205  
0388, 0500, 0507,  
0575, 0658  
0775, 0851  
0136, 0314,  
0587  
0190, 0388  
0207, 0460  
0181, 0193, 0277,  
0677  
FINLUX  
0064, 0131, 0132,  
0373, 0543  
0036, 0263  
0036, 0274, 0695  
0131, 0181, 0235,  
0397  
FIRSTAR  
FIRSTLINE  
FISHER  
JENSEN  
KEC  
KTV  
0207  
NORCENT  
NORDMENDE  
SABA  
0057, 0207  
0036  
KAISUI  
SACCS  
FLINT  
0482  
KAPSCH  
KARCHER  
KATHREIN  
KENDO  
KENWOOD  
KNEISSEL  
KOLIN  
KORPEL  
KOYODA  
L&S ELECTRONIC 0835  
0190  
0637  
0583  
0064  
OCEANIC  
ONWA  
OPTIMUS  
SAGEM  
SAISHO  
SALORA  
FORMENTI  
FORTRESS  
0064, 0347  
0120  
0036, 0291, 0543  
0190, 0380, 0388,  
0575  
FRONTECH 0190, 0274, 0291  
FUJITSU  
FUNAI  
FUTURETECH  
GE  
0710, 0836  
0207, 0198, 0291  
0207  
0057, 0074, 0078,  
0119, 0205, 0207,  
0478, 0587, 1174,  
1374, 1481  
0064, 0543  
1782, 1783  
0036  
0057  
OPTONICA  
ORION  
0120  
SAMBERS  
SAMPO  
0543  
0286, 0462  
0080, 0135, 0207  
0064  
0064, 0263, 0347,  
0490, 0543  
0291, 0439  
0036, 0057, 0119,  
0120, 0181, 0198,  
0205, 0677, 1782  
0036, 0057, 0064,  
0087, 0117, 0119,  
0181, 0205, 0291,  
0397, 0583, 0614,  
0645, 0729, 0793,  
0839, 0841  
0478  
0036  
OSAKI  
OTTO VERSAND  
0539, 0583  
PALLADIUM 0397, 0445  
PANAMA 0291  
PANASONIC 0064, 0078, 0081,  
0190, 0277, 0677,  
1437  
PATHE CINEMA  
PAUSA  
PENNEY  
0064, 0347,  
SAMSUNG  
LG  
0057, 0064, 0087,  
GEC  
0135, 0205, 0741  
0074, 0081, 0181,  
0183, 0205  
GATEWAY  
GELOSO  
GENEXXA  
LXI  
0190  
LEYCO  
LIESENK & TTER 0064  
LOEWE  
LUXOR  
M ELECTRONIC  
0064, 0291  
SANSEI  
SANSUI  
SANYO  
GIBRALTER 0044, 0057  
GOLDSTAR 0057, 0064, 0136,  
0181, 0205, 0404  
GOODMANS 0064, 0398, 0401,  
0661  
0539  
0265, 0347  
0490  
0131, 0181, 0207,  
0235, 0366, 0826  
0383, 0388  
0036  
0036, 0064,  
0057, 0074, 0078,  
0087, 0183, 0205,  
1374  
SCHAUB LORENZ 0388  
SCHNEIDER 0064, 0274, 0398,  
0695  
SCOTCH  
SCOTT  
0131, 0132, 0136,  
0190, 0314, 0373,  
0401, 0507  
0057, 0177, 0205  
0057, 0087, 0539  
GOREMJE  
GRADIENTE 0080, 0197  
GRAETZ 0190, 0388  
0397  
PERDIO  
PHILCO  
0347  
0057, 0064, 0081,  
0172, 0205, 0207,  
0274, 0490, 1688  
0205  
0205, 0207, 0263  
MGA  
MTC  
APPENDIX-vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
UHER  
0347  
COMBITECH 0379  
KAISUI  
KENWOOD  
KODAK  
KOLIN  
KORPEL  
LG  
0099  
SEARS  
0074, 0081, 0181,  
0183, 0198, 0205  
0190, 0286  
0207  
0183  
UNIVERSUM 0064, 0131, 0132,  
CRAIG  
0064, 0074, 0099,  
0068, 0094  
0062, 0064  
0068, 0070  
0099  
0064, 0069, 0072,  
0507  
SELECO  
SEMIVOX  
SEMP  
SHARP  
SHEN YING 0036, 0119  
0291, 0373, 0397,  
0267  
0519  
VECTOR RESEARCH  
0057  
VESTEL  
VICTOR  
CROWN  
0099, 0305  
CURTIS MATHES 0062, 0068,  
0087, 1062  
CYBERNEX 0267  
0057, 0120, 0677  
0064  
0080, 0277, 0677,  
CYRUS  
0108  
LXI  
0064  
SHENG CHIA 0036, 0120, 0263  
0680  
0274  
0081  
0205  
DAEWOO  
0072, 0131, 0305,  
0669, 1305  
0099  
0069  
0027, 0108  
0069  
LENCO  
LEYCO  
LLOYD’S  
LOEWE  
LOGIK  
LUXOR  
M ELECTRONIC  
MEI  
MGA  
MGN TECHNOLOGY  
0267  
MTC  
MAGNASONIC  
MAGNAVOX 0027, 0062, 0066,  
0108, 1808  
0305  
0099  
0027  
0064, 0108, 1589  
0099, 0267  
0070, 0075, 0131  
SIAREM  
0543  
0064, 0222  
0543  
0383  
0207  
SIEMENS  
SINUDYNE  
SKANTIC  
SKYGIANT  
VIDEOSAT  
VIDIKRON  
VIDTECH  
DANSAI  
DE GRAAF  
DECCA  
DENON  
DUAL  
DUMONT  
DYNATECH 0027  
ESC  
ELCATECH  
VIEWSONIC 1782  
SKYWORTH 0064  
VISION  
0347  
0190  
0383  
0057, 0081, 0205,  
0893  
VOXSON  
WALTHAM  
WARDS  
0068  
0027, 0108, 0131  
0027  
SOLAVOX  
SONITRON  
SONOKO  
SONOLOR  
SONTEC  
SONY  
0190  
0235  
0062  
0070, 0267  
0036, 0064  
0190, 0235  
0064  
0027, 0677, 0861,  
1127, 1532, 1678  
0205, 0207  
0064, 0445  
0078, 0087, 0119,  
0183, 0205  
0198  
0267, 0305  
0099  
WATSON  
WAYCON  
0064, 0347  
0183  
ELECTROHOME  
ELECTROPHONIC 0064  
EMEREX  
0064  
0027, 0267  
1305  
WHITE WESTINGHOUSE  
0064, 0347, 0490,  
SOUNDESIGN  
SOUNDWAVE  
SOWA  
0059  
0650  
EMERSON  
0027, 0062, 0064,  
0070, 0072, 0211,  
0267, 0305, 1305,  
1506  
YAMAHA  
0057, 0172, 0677,  
0796, 0860,  
2900 (projector),  
2901 (projector),  
2903,  
2904 (projector)  
0277  
0064, 0291  
0044, 0119, 0205,  
0490  
MAGNIN  
0267  
MANESTH  
MARANTZ  
MARTA  
MATSUI  
MATSUSHITA  
MEDION  
0072, 0099  
0062, 0108  
0064  
0375, 0379  
0062  
SQUAREVIEW  
STANDARD 0036  
STARLITE  
STERN  
SUPREME  
SYLVANIA  
FERGUSON 0068, 0347  
FIDELITY 0027  
FINLANDIA 0108, 0131  
0207  
0190, 0286  
0027  
YAPSHE  
YOKO  
ZENITH  
FINLUX  
0027, 0069, 0108,  
0131  
0375  
MEMOREX  
0027, 0062, 0064,  
0066, 0074, 0075,  
0131, 0267, 0334,  
0375, 1264  
0099  
0057, 0081, 0198  
SYMPHONIC 0198, 0207  
SYNCO  
FIRSTLINE  
0064, 0070, 0072,  
0099  
0074, 0131  
0060, 0062  
0027, 0072  
0027  
0062, 0087, 0267,  
0834, 1062, 1087  
0108  
0027, 0087, 0119,  
0120, 0205, 0478  
0064  
0474  
0835  
0205  
0044  
0490  
0036, 0119, 0205  
0036  
0120, 0190  
0119, 0677  
0036, 0064, 0078,  
0081, 0087, 0181,  
0183, 0543  
0036, 0064, 0291,  
0439, 0445, 0482,  
0695, 1064  
0274  
FISHER  
FUJI  
FUJITSU  
FUNAI  
GE  
MEMPHIS  
METZ  
MINOLTA  
MITSUBISHI 0068, 0070, 0094,  
0108, 0834  
MOTOROLA 0062, 0075  
MULTITECH 0027, 0099  
MURPHY  
MYRYAD  
NAD  
SYSLINE  
T + A  
TCM  
TMK  
TNCI  
VCR  
ASA  
ADMIRAL  
0064, 0374, 1589  
0069  
0064, 0108  
0075  
ADVENTURA 0027  
TVS  
AIKO  
AIWA  
0305  
GEC  
TACICO  
TAI YI  
TANDY  
TASHIKO  
TATUNG  
0027, 0064, 0334,  
0375, 0379  
0068, 0342  
0099  
0099, 0305, 0342,  
0379  
GARRARD  
GENERAL  
GO VIDEO  
GOLDHAND 0099  
GOLDSTAR 0064, 0252, 0507,  
1264  
GOODMANS 0027, 0064, 0099,  
0305  
GRADIENTE 0027  
0027  
0072  
0459  
0027  
0108  
0131  
0062, 0064, 0068,  
0075, 0094, 0131  
0253  
AKAI  
AKIBA  
ALBA  
NEC  
NATIONAL  
NECKERMANN  
NESCO  
NEWAVE  
NIKKO  
AMERICA ACTION 0305  
AMERICAN HIGH 0062  
0108  
TEAC  
TEC  
TECHNEMA 0347  
TECHNICS  
0099  
0064  
0064  
0267  
AMSTRAD  
ANAM  
0027  
0064, 0253, 0267,  
0305, 0507  
GRAETZ  
0068, 0131, 0267  
0108, 0131  
0027, 0064, 0099  
0099, 0108, 0253,  
0374  
GRANADA  
GRANDIN  
GRUNDIG  
NOBLEX  
NOKIA  
ANAM NATIONAL 0253, 1589  
0068, 0131, 0267  
0068, 0347  
0027, 0068  
0342, 0375  
0062, 0253  
0064, 0075, 0131,  
0459  
0211, 0375, 0379,  
1506  
0027, 0064, 0099  
0078, 0277, 0677  
ANITECH  
ASHA  
ASUKA  
0099  
0267  
0064  
NORDMENDE  
OCEANIC  
OKANO  
OLYMPUS  
OPTIMUS  
TECHWOOD 0078  
TECO  
0036, 0078, 0119,  
0120, 0205, 0291,  
0680  
0081, 0087, 0119,  
0177, 0207  
0136, 0289,  
0362, 0652, 0729  
0347  
HCM  
HI-Q  
0099  
0074  
AUDIOVOX 0064, 0305  
BAIRD  
0027, 0068, 0131  
HANSEATIC 0064  
HARLEY DAVIDSON  
0027  
HARMAN/KARDON 0108  
HARWOOD  
HINARI  
TEKNIKA  
BASIC LINE 0099, 0305  
BEAUMARK 0267  
BELL & HOWELL 0131  
BLAUPUNKT 0253  
ORION  
OSAKI  
TELEFUNKEN  
0099  
TELEMEISTER  
TELETECH  
TENSAI  
TERA  
THOMSON  
BRANDT  
0347  
0099, 0267, 0379  
0027, 0064, 0068,  
0069, 0267  
HITACHI  
OTTO VERSAND  
0108  
0036  
0347  
0057  
BRANDT ELECTRONIC  
0068  
BROKSONIC 0211, 0375, 1506  
PALLADIUM 0064, 0068, 0099  
PANASONIC 0062, 0252, 0253,  
0643, 1062, 1589  
PATHE MARCONI 0068  
PENNEY  
HUGHES NETWORK SYSTEMS  
0069  
HYPSON  
ITT  
ITV  
IMPERIAL  
INTERFUNK 0108  
JVC  
JENSEN  
KEC  
KLH  
0136, 0314, 0587,  
0652, 1474  
0064, 0131, 0388,  
0539  
0087, 0181, 0183,  
0535, 0645, 0677,  
0859, 1283, 1383,  
1683, 1731  
0543  
BUSH  
CCE  
CGE  
CALIX  
CANON  
CARVER  
CIMLINE  
CINERAL  
CITIZEN  
COLT  
0099, 0305, 0379  
0099, 0305  
0027  
0064  
0062  
0108  
0099  
0305  
0064, 0305, 1305  
0099  
0099  
0068, 0131, 0267  
0064, 0305  
0027  
0062, 0064, 0069,  
0267, 1062, 1264  
0069  
0027  
0062  
0062, 0108, 0645,  
1108, 1208  
0108  
THORN  
PENTAX  
PERDIO  
PHILCO  
PHILIPS  
TOSHIBA  
0068, 0072, 0094  
0068  
0064, 0305  
0099  
TRIUMPH  
TUNTEX  
PHONOLA  
0036, 0057, 0119  
APPENDIX-viii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PILOT  
PIONEER  
POLK AUDIO 0108  
PROFITRONIC  
PROLINE  
PROSCAN  
PROTEC  
PULSAR  
PYE  
0064  
0069, 0094, 0108  
TELEAVIA  
TELEFUNKEN  
TENOSAL  
TENSAI  
THOMAS  
THOMSON  
0068  
0068, 0347  
0099  
0027  
0027  
0068, 0087, 0094,  
0347  
0267  
0027  
0087, 1087  
0099  
0066  
0108  
THORN  
TIVO  
0068, 0131  
0645, 0663  
QUASAR  
QUELLE  
RCA  
0062, 1062  
0108  
0062, 0069, 0087,  
0267, 0834, 1062,  
1087  
TOSHIBA  
0068, 0070, 0072,  
0094, 0108, 0872  
TOTEVISION 0064, 0267  
UHER  
UNITECH  
0267  
0267  
RADIOSHACK  
RADIOLA  
RADIX  
0027  
UNIVERSUM 0027, 0064, 0108,  
0267  
0108  
0064  
0064  
VECTOR  
VICTOR  
0072  
0068, 0094  
RANDEX  
REALISTIC  
0027, 0062, 0064,  
0074, 0075, 0131  
0375  
VIDEO CONCEPTS 0072  
VIDEOMAGIC  
0064  
REOC  
VIDEOSONIC 0267  
REPLAYTV  
REX  
ROADSTAR 0064, 0099, 0267,  
0305  
0641, 0643  
0068  
VILLAIN  
WARDS  
0027  
0027, 0062, 0069,  
0074, 0075, 0087,  
0099, 0108, 0267  
RUNCO  
SBR  
0066  
0108  
WHITE WESTINGHOUSE  
0099  
SEG  
SEI  
STS  
SABA  
SALORA  
SAMPO  
SAMSUNG  
SANKY  
SANSUI  
0267  
0108  
0069  
0068, 0347  
0070  
0064, 0075  
0072, 0267, 0459  
0066, 0075  
0027, 0068, 0094,  
1506  
XR-1000  
YAMAHA  
YAMISHI  
YOKAN  
YOKO  
0027, 0062, 0099  
0068  
0099  
0099  
0267  
0027, 0060, 0066,  
1506  
ZENITH  
SANYO  
SAVILLE  
0074, 0131, 0267  
0379  
SCHAUB LORENZ 0027, 0068,  
0131  
SCHNEIDER 0027, 0099, 0108  
SCOTT  
SEARS  
0070, 0072, 0211  
0027, 0062, 0064,  
0069, 0074, 0131,  
1264  
SELECO  
SEMP  
0068  
0072  
SHARP  
0075, 0834  
0099, 0131  
0064, 0108, 0131  
0064  
SHINTOM  
SIEMENS  
SILVA  
SINGER  
SINUDYNE  
0072, 0099  
0108  
SONIC BLUE 0641, 0643  
SONTEC  
SONY  
0064  
0027, 0059, 0060,  
0062, 0663, 1259  
0375  
SUNKAI  
SUNSTAR  
0027  
SUNTRONIC 0027  
SYLVANIA 0027, 0062, 0108,  
0070, 1808  
SYMPHONIC 0027  
TMK  
0267  
TANDY  
TASHIKO  
TATUNG  
0027, 0131  
0027, 0064  
0027, 0068, 0072,  
0094, 0108  
TEAC  
0027, 0068, 0305,  
0334, 0669  
TECHNICS  
TECO  
0062, 0253  
0062, 0064, 0068,  
0075  
TEKNIKA  
0027, 0062, 0064  
APPENDIX-ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Weider Home Gym 831159530 User Manual
Weslo Treadmill WLTL21191 User Manual
Whirlpool Oven GSC309 User Manual
Whirlpool Washer DESIGN 2000 User Manual
Xerox Copier Copy centre; C118 Work Centre; M118 User Manual
Xerox Printer 4512 User Manual
Xpelair Fan CX10 User Manual
Zagg Portable Speaker 780MV50MV User Manual
Zephyr Ventilation Hood AK8000AS User Manual
Zephyr Ventilation Hood ZVE E36S User Manual